1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.33 2008/01/30 14:56:54 fanf2 Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.69"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>23 August 2007</date>
176 <author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
178 <affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
179 <address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
180 <revhistory><revision>
181 <revnumber>4.68</revnumber>
182 <date>23 August 2007</date>
183 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>2007</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
192 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
193 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
196 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 <indexterm role="variable">
200 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
201 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
203 <indexterm role="concept">
204 <primary>address</primary>
205 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
206 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CR character</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CRL</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>delivery</primary>
226 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
227 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>dialup</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>exiscan</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>failover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>fallover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>filter</primary>
247 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
248 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>ident</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>LF character</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>maximum</primary>
260 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>monitor</primary>
264 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
268 <see>entry for xxx</see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>NUL</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>passwd file</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>process id</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>RBL</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>redirection</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>return path</primary>
292 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>scanning</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>SSL</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>string</primary>
304 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
305 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>top bit</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>variables</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
325 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
326 . chapter "Introduction"
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
329 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
330 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
331 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
332 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
334 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
335 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
336 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
337 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
338 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
339 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
340 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
342 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
343 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
344 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
346 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
347 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
348 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
350 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
351 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
352 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
353 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
354 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
356 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
357 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
358 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
359 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
360 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
362 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
363 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
364 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
365 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
369 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
370 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
372 .cindex "documentation"
373 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
374 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
375 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
376 capable of showing a change indicator.
379 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
380 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
381 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
382 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
383 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
384 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
385 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
388 .cindex "books about Exim"
389 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
390 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
391 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
392 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
395 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
396 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
397 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
400 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
401 Debian-specific features in the file
402 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
403 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
406 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
407 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
410 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
411 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
412 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
413 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
416 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
417 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
418 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
421 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
424 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
425 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
430 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
431 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
432 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
433 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
434 .row &_pcrepattern.txt_& "specification of PCRE regular expressions"
435 .row &_pcretest.txt_& "specification of the PCRE testing program"
436 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
437 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
450 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
451 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
452 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
453 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
454 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
458 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
459 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
460 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
461 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
462 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
466 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
467 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
471 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
472 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
473 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
482 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
483 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
484 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
485 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
486 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
495 .cindex "training courses"
496 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
497 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
498 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
499 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
502 .cindex "bug reports"
503 .cindex "reporting bugs"
504 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
505 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
506 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
507 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
511 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
514 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
520 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
523 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
524 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
527 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
528 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
529 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
535 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
536 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
539 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
540 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
541 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
542 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
543 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
546 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
547 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
549 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
550 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
551 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
553 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
554 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
555 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
556 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
558 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
560 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
561 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
563 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
564 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
567 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
569 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
570 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
571 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
572 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
573 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
574 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
575 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
577 .cindex "domainless addresses"
578 .cindex "address" "without domain"
579 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
580 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
581 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
582 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
585 .cindex "transport" "external"
586 .cindex "external transports"
587 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
588 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
589 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
590 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
591 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
592 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
594 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
595 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
596 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
599 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
600 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
601 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
602 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
603 a number of common scanners are provided.
607 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
608 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
609 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
610 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
611 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
612 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
615 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
616 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
617 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
618 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
619 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
620 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
621 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
622 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
623 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
624 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
625 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
626 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
628 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
629 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
630 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
631 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
635 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
636 .cindex "terminology definitions"
637 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
638 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
639 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
640 below) by a blank line.
642 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
643 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
644 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
645 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
646 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
647 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
648 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
649 rise to further bounce messages.
651 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
652 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
653 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
656 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
657 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
658 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
661 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
662 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
663 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
665 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
666 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
667 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
668 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
669 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
670 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
671 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
672 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
674 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
675 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
676 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
677 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
678 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
679 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
682 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
683 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
684 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
685 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
686 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
688 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
689 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
690 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
691 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
692 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
693 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
695 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
696 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
699 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
700 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
701 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
702 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
703 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
705 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
707 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
708 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
709 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
711 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
712 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
713 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
714 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
715 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
716 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
726 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
727 .cindex "incorporated code"
728 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
730 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
733 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
734 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
735 © University of Cambridge. The source to a cut down version of PCRE
736 used to be distributed in the directory &_src/pcre_&. However, this is
737 no longer the case and you will need to use a system PCRE library or
738 obtain and install the full version of the library from
739 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
741 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
742 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
743 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
744 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
745 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
746 following statements:
749 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
751 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
752 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
753 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
755 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
756 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
757 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
758 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
759 restrictions applied to it).
762 .cindex "SPA authentication"
763 .cindex "Samba project"
764 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
765 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
766 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
767 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
771 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
772 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
773 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
774 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
775 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
776 conditions expressed therein.
779 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
781 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
782 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
786 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
787 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
789 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
790 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
791 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
794 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
795 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
796 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
797 details, please contact
799 Office of Technology Transfer
800 Carnegie Mellon University
802 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
803 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
804 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
807 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
810 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
811 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
813 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
814 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
815 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
816 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
817 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
818 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
819 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
824 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
827 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
828 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
829 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
830 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
833 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
834 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
838 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
839 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
840 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
841 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
842 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
843 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
844 software without specific, written prior permission.
846 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
847 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
848 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
849 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
850 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
851 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
856 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
857 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
858 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
868 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
869 "Receiving and delivering mail"
872 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
873 .cindex "design philosophy"
874 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
875 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
876 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
877 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
878 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
879 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
882 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
883 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
884 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
885 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
886 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
887 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
888 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
891 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
892 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
893 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
894 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
895 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
896 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
897 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
898 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
899 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
902 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
903 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
905 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
906 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
907 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
908 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
910 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
911 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
912 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
913 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
914 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
916 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
917 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
918 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
920 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
921 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
922 runs at the start of every delivery process.
927 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
928 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
929 .cindex "Sieve filter"
930 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
931 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
932 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
933 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
934 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
935 of filtering are available:
938 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
941 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
942 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
945 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
949 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
950 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
951 .cindex "format" "of message id"
952 .cindex "id of message"
957 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
958 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
959 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
960 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
961 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
962 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
963 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
964 not always case-sensitive.
966 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
967 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
968 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
969 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
970 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
971 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
975 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
976 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
977 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
978 way of representing the date and time of day).
980 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
981 received the message.
983 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
985 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
986 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
987 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
988 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
989 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
991 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
992 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
997 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
998 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
999 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1000 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1001 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1004 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1005 .cindex "receiving mail"
1006 .cindex "message" "reception"
1007 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1008 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1009 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1010 there are several possibilities:
1013 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1014 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1015 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1017 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1018 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1019 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1020 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1021 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1022 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1024 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1025 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1026 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1027 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1028 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1030 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1031 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1032 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1033 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1037 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1038 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1039 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1040 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1041 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1042 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1043 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1044 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1045 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1046 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1047 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1048 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1049 users to change sender addresses.
1051 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1052 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1053 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1054 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1055 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1056 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1057 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1059 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1060 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1061 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1062 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1063 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1064 message is received.
1070 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1071 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1072 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1073 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1074 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1075 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1076 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1077 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1079 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1080 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1081 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1082 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1083 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1084 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1085 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1086 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1087 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1088 affect file system performance.
1090 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1091 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1092 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1093 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1094 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1096 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1097 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1098 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1099 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1100 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1101 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1102 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1103 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1104 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1105 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1106 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1107 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1111 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1112 .cindex "message" "life of"
1113 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1114 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1115 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1116 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1117 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1118 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1119 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1121 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1122 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1123 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1124 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1125 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1128 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1129 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1130 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1131 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1132 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1134 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1135 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1136 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1137 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1138 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1139 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1140 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1141 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1142 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1143 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1146 .cindex "journal file"
1147 .cindex "file" "journal"
1148 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1149 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1150 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1151 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1152 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1153 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1154 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1155 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1157 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1158 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1159 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1160 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1161 deliveries caused by crashes.
1165 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1166 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1167 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1168 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1169 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1170 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1171 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1172 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1173 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1175 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1176 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1177 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1178 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1179 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1180 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1181 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1182 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1183 the driver's features in general.
1185 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1186 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1187 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1188 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1191 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1192 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1193 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1194 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1195 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1196 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1198 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1199 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1200 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1201 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1202 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1203 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1205 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1206 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1207 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1210 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1211 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1212 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1213 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1214 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1215 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1216 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1217 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1218 configured to fail the address.
1220 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1221 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1222 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1223 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1224 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1225 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1227 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1228 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1229 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1230 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1231 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1232 the address is bounced.
1236 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1237 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1238 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1239 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1240 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1241 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1242 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1243 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1245 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1246 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1247 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1248 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1249 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1250 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1251 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1252 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1257 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1258 .cindex "router" "running details"
1259 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1260 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1261 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1262 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1263 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1264 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1268 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1269 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1270 original address ceases,
1271 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1272 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1273 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1274 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1275 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1278 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1279 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1280 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1281 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1282 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1284 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1285 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1286 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1287 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1288 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1290 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1291 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1292 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1293 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1294 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1296 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1297 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1298 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1300 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1301 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1302 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1303 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1305 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1306 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1309 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1310 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1311 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1312 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1313 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1315 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1316 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1317 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1318 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1319 facility for this purpose.
1322 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1323 .cindex "case of local parts"
1324 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1325 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1326 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1327 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1328 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1329 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1330 routed addresses are shown.
1334 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1335 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1336 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1337 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1338 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1339 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1342 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1343 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1344 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1345 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1346 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1347 of any other conditions.
1349 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1350 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1351 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1353 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1354 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1355 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1356 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1358 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1359 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1360 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1361 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1362 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1364 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1365 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1367 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1368 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1370 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1371 of domains that it defines.
1373 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1374 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1375 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1376 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1377 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1378 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1379 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1380 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1381 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1382 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1384 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1385 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1387 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1388 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1389 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1390 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1391 remaining preconditions.
1393 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1394 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1395 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1396 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1397 could lead to confusion.
1399 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1400 set of addresses that it defines.
1402 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1403 specified files is tested.
1405 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1406 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1407 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1408 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1412 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1413 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1414 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1415 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1416 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1417 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1418 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1422 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1423 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1424 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1427 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1428 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1429 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1430 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1431 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1433 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1434 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1436 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1437 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1438 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1439 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1440 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1441 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1444 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1445 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1446 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1447 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1448 processed entirely independently of each other.
1450 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1451 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1452 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1453 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1454 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1455 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1456 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1457 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1458 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1460 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1461 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1462 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1463 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1464 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1465 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1466 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1467 addresses to the same domain.
1469 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1470 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1471 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1472 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1473 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1474 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1475 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1476 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1478 .cindex "queue runner"
1479 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1480 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1481 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1482 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1483 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1484 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1485 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1486 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1487 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1489 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1490 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1491 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1492 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1493 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1494 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1496 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1497 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1498 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1499 messages to other addresses.
1501 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1502 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1503 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1506 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1507 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1508 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1514 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1516 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1517 .cindex "queue runner"
1518 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1519 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1520 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1521 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1522 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1523 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1524 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1525 passed its retry time.
1526 You can run several queue runners at once.
1528 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1529 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1530 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1531 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1532 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1537 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1538 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1539 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1540 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1541 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1542 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1543 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1544 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1545 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1548 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1549 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1550 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1553 .cindex "hints database"
1554 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1555 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1556 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1557 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1563 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1565 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1566 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1567 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1568 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1569 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1570 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1571 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1572 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1573 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1575 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1576 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1577 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1580 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1581 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1582 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1583 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1584 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1585 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1586 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1591 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1592 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1593 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1594 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1595 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1596 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1597 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1598 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1607 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1608 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1610 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1611 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1612 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1613 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1616 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1617 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1619 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1620 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1621 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1622 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1626 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1627 following subdirectories are created:
1630 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1631 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1632 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1633 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1634 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1635 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1636 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1639 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1640 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1641 that may be useful to some sites.
1644 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1645 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1646 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1647 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1648 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1649 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1651 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1652 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1653 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1654 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1655 overridden if necessary.
1658 .section "PCRE library" "SECTdb"
1659 .cindex "PCRE library"
1660 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1661 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1662 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1663 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1664 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1665 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1666 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1667 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1668 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1670 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1671 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1672 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1673 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1674 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1675 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1676 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1678 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1679 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1680 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1681 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1682 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1683 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1684 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1685 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1687 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1688 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1689 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1690 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1691 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1692 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1693 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1694 Berkeley DB library.
1696 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1697 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1701 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1702 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1704 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1705 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1706 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1707 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1708 file name is used unmodified.
1710 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1711 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1712 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1713 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1715 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1716 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1717 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1719 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1720 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1721 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1722 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1723 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1724 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1726 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1727 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1728 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1729 operates on a single file.
1733 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1734 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1735 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1736 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1737 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1741 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1742 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1744 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1745 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1746 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1747 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1748 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1749 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1751 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1752 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1753 in one of these lines:
1758 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1759 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1760 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1761 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1764 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1765 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1767 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1768 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1772 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1773 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1774 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1775 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1776 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1777 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1778 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1779 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1780 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1781 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1782 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1783 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1785 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1786 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1787 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1788 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1789 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1790 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1792 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1793 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1794 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1795 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1796 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1797 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1800 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1801 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1802 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1803 facilities, you need to set
1805 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1807 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1808 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1811 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1812 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1813 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1814 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1815 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1816 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1817 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1819 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1820 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1821 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1822 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1823 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1828 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1829 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1831 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1832 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1833 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1834 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1835 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1836 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1837 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1839 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1840 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1841 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1842 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1843 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1847 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1851 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1852 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1853 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1854 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1855 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1856 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1857 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1858 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1859 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1860 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1863 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1864 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1867 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1870 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1872 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1873 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1876 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1877 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1879 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1880 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1884 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1886 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1887 library and include files. For example:
1891 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1892 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1894 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1895 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1896 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1901 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1902 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1903 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1904 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1905 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1906 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1907 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1908 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1909 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1910 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1911 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1914 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1915 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1916 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1918 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1919 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1921 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1923 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1924 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1925 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1930 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1931 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1932 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1933 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1934 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1935 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1938 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1939 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1940 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1941 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1942 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1943 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1944 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1945 support has not been tested for some time.
1949 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1950 .cindex "build directory"
1951 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1952 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1953 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1954 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1955 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1956 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1957 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1959 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1960 building process fails if it is set.
1962 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1963 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1964 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1965 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1966 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1967 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1968 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1969 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1971 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1972 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1973 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1977 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1978 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1979 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1980 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1981 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1982 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1983 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1987 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1988 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1989 given in addition to the short output.
1993 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1994 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1995 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1996 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1997 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1998 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1999 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2002 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2003 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2005 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2006 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2007 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2008 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2010 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2011 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2012 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2013 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2014 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2015 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2016 and are often not needed.
2018 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2019 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2020 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2021 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2022 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2023 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2024 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2025 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2026 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2029 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2030 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2031 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2032 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2036 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2037 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2038 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2039 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2040 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2041 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2042 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2043 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2044 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2045 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2046 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2047 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2048 containing the lines
2053 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2054 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2056 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2057 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2058 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2061 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2062 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2063 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2064 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2065 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2066 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2067 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2068 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2069 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2070 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2076 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2077 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2078 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2079 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2080 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2081 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2082 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2083 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2086 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2087 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2088 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2092 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2093 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2095 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2096 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2097 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2098 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2099 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2100 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2103 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2104 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2106 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2107 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2110 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2111 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2113 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2114 definition of all three of these variables into your
2115 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2118 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2119 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2120 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2121 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2123 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2124 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2125 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2126 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2127 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2130 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2131 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2132 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2133 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2134 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2137 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2139 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2140 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2141 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2142 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2143 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2144 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2148 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2149 .cindex "building Eximon"
2150 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2151 where the files that are involved are
2153 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2154 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2156 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2157 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2158 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2160 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2161 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2162 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2163 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2164 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2165 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2166 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2170 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2171 .cindex "installing Exim"
2172 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2173 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2174 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2175 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2176 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2177 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2178 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2179 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2180 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2181 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2182 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2183 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2185 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2186 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2187 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2188 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2189 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2190 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2191 alternative files, no default is installed.
2193 .cindex "system aliases file"
2194 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2195 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2196 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2197 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2198 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2199 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2200 and outputs a comment to the user.
2202 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2203 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2204 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2205 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2206 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2208 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2209 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2210 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2211 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2212 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2215 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2216 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2219 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2221 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2222 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2223 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2224 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2225 but this usage is deprecated.
2227 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2228 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2229 &'convert4r4'&, or the &'pcretest'& test program. You will probably run the
2230 first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2231 isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2232 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2233 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2235 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2236 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2237 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2238 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2239 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2240 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2241 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2243 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2244 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2245 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2248 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2250 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2251 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2252 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2253 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2256 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2258 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2259 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2262 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2263 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2265 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2269 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2271 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2273 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2274 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2275 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2277 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2282 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2283 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2284 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2285 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2286 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2289 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2290 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2291 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2295 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2296 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2297 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2298 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2299 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2305 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2306 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2307 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2308 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2309 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2313 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2314 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2315 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2316 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2317 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2320 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2322 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2324 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2326 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2327 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2328 user agent. For example:
2330 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2331 From: user@your.domain.example
2332 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2333 Subject: Testing Exim
2335 This is a test message.
2338 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2339 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2340 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2342 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2343 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2344 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2345 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2346 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2347 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2349 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2351 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2352 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2353 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2354 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2355 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2357 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2358 .cindex "lock files"
2359 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2360 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2361 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2362 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2363 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2364 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2365 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2366 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2367 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2368 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2369 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2370 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2372 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2373 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2374 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2375 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2376 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2379 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2380 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2381 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2382 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2386 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2387 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2388 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2389 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2390 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2391 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2392 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2393 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2394 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2395 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2396 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2397 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2398 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2400 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2401 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2402 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2403 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2404 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2405 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2408 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2409 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2410 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2411 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2413 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2414 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2415 favourite user agent.
2417 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2418 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2419 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2420 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2421 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2422 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2426 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2427 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2428 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2429 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2430 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2431 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2432 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2433 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2439 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2440 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2441 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2443 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2445 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2446 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2447 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2448 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2449 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2451 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2453 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2455 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2456 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2457 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2465 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2466 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2467 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2468 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2469 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2470 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2471 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2472 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2473 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2476 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2478 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2479 were present before any other options.
2480 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2482 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2483 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2484 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2487 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2488 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2489 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2493 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2494 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2495 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2498 .cindex "queue runner"
2499 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2500 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2501 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2503 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2504 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2505 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2506 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2507 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2508 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2509 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2510 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2513 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2514 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2515 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2516 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2517 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2518 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2521 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2522 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2523 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2524 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2525 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2526 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2528 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2529 .cindex "envelope sender"
2530 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2531 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2532 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2533 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2534 users to set envelope senders.
2536 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2537 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2538 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2539 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2540 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2542 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2543 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2544 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2545 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2546 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2547 that are available to trusted users.
2549 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2550 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2551 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2552 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2553 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2555 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2556 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2557 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2558 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2560 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2561 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2562 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2563 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2565 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2566 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2571 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2572 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2573 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2579 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2580 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2581 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2582 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2583 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2584 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2585 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2586 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2589 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2590 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2591 . creates a man page for the options.
2592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2595 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2602 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2603 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2604 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2605 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2608 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2609 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2610 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2613 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2615 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2616 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2617 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2618 clean; it ignores this option.
2623 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2624 .cindex "queue runner"
2625 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2626 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2627 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2629 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2630 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2631 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2632 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2634 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2635 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2636 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2637 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2639 When a listening daemon
2640 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2641 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2642 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2643 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2644 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2645 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2648 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2649 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2650 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2654 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2655 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2656 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2657 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2658 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2659 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2660 because these are reread each time they are used.
2664 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2665 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2669 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2670 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2671 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2672 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2673 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2674 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2676 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2677 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2678 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2679 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2680 test data. A line history is supported.
2682 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2683 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2684 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2685 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2686 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2687 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2688 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2690 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2691 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2692 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2693 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2695 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2697 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2698 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2699 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2700 of a file. For example:
2702 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2704 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2705 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2706 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2707 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2708 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2709 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2710 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2713 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2715 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2716 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2717 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2718 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2719 system filters are recognized.
2721 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2723 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2724 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2725 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2726 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2727 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2728 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2729 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2730 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2733 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2734 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2735 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2737 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2739 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2740 variables that are used by the user filter.
2742 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2747 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2748 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2749 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2752 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2753 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2754 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2755 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2757 When testing a filter file,
2758 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2759 .cindex "envelope sender"
2760 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2761 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2762 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2763 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2764 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2767 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2769 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2770 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2771 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2774 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2776 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2777 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2778 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2779 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2780 actually being delivered.
2782 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2784 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2785 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2788 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2790 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2791 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2794 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2796 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2797 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2798 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2799 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2800 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2801 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2802 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2803 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2804 after a full stop. For example:
2806 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2807 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2809 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2810 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2811 conversion to the canonical form is
2812 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2814 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2815 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2816 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2817 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2818 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2822 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2823 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2824 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2827 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2828 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2829 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2831 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2832 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2833 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2834 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2835 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2836 session were authenticated.
2838 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2839 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2840 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2842 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2843 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2844 specialized SMTP test program such as
2845 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2847 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2849 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2850 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2851 updating the callout cache database.
2855 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2856 .cindex "building alias file"
2857 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2858 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2859 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2860 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2861 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2864 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2865 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2866 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2867 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2868 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2869 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2874 .cindex "local message reception"
2875 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2876 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2877 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2878 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2879 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2880 if no other conflicting option is present.
2882 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2883 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2884 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2885 suppressing this for special cases.
2887 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2888 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2890 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2891 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2892 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2895 .cindex "message" "format"
2896 .cindex "format" "message"
2897 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2898 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2899 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2900 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2901 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2903 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2904 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2906 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2907 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2908 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2909 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2910 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2912 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2913 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2914 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2915 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2916 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2920 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2921 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2922 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2923 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2924 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2925 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2926 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2928 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2929 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2930 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2931 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2932 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2934 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2935 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2936 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2937 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2942 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2943 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2944 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2945 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2946 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2947 arguments, for example:
2949 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2951 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2952 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2953 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2954 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2955 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2956 users, the output is as in this example:
2958 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2960 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2961 configuration file is output.
2962 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2963 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2965 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2966 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2967 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2968 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2969 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2970 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2971 written directly into the spool directory.
2973 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2975 exim -bP +local_domains
2977 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2978 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2980 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2981 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2982 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2983 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2984 that driver are output. For example:
2986 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2988 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2989 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2990 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2991 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2992 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2998 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
2999 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3000 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3001 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3002 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3003 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3004 to allow any user to see the queue.
3006 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3008 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3009 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3012 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3013 .cindex "size" "of message"
3014 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3015 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3016 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3017 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3018 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3019 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3020 before the sender address.
3022 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3023 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3024 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3026 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3027 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3028 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3029 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3030 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3036 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3037 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3038 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3044 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3045 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3046 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3047 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3052 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3053 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3054 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3055 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3059 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3063 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3068 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3069 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3070 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3071 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3076 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3077 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3078 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3079 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3080 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3082 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3083 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3085 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3086 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3087 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3088 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3089 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3090 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3091 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3092 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3093 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3095 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3096 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3101 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3102 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3103 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3104 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3105 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3106 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3107 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3111 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3112 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3113 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3114 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3115 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3116 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3117 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3118 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3119 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3121 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3122 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3123 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3125 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3126 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3127 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3128 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3130 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3131 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3132 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3134 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3135 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3136 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3137 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3138 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3140 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3141 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3145 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3146 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3147 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3148 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3149 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3150 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3151 messages to the MTA.
3154 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3155 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3156 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3157 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3158 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3159 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3160 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3164 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3165 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3166 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3167 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3168 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3169 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3170 the listening daemon.
3174 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3175 .cindex "address" "testing"
3176 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3177 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3178 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3179 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3180 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3182 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3183 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3185 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3186 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3189 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3190 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3191 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3192 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3193 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3196 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3197 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3198 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3199 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3201 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3202 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3203 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3204 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3207 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3208 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3210 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3211 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3212 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3213 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3214 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3215 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3220 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3221 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3222 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3223 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3224 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3225 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3227 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3228 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3229 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3230 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3231 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3232 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3233 dynamic testing facilities.
3237 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3238 .cindex "address" "verification"
3239 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3240 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3241 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3242 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3243 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3244 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3246 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3247 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3248 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3250 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3251 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3253 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3254 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3257 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3258 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3259 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3260 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3261 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3263 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3264 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3265 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3266 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3267 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3268 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3271 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3272 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3273 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3276 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3277 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3278 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3279 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3281 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3282 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3283 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3284 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3288 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3289 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3292 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3294 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3295 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3296 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3297 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3298 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3299 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3300 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3301 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3302 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3304 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3305 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3306 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3307 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3308 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3311 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3312 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3313 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3314 the packagers might have enabled it.
3316 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3317 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3318 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3319 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3320 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3321 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3322 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3324 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3325 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3326 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3327 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3328 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3329 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3330 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3332 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3333 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3334 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3337 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3338 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3339 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3340 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3341 specified by this option.
3343 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3345 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3346 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3347 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3348 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3349 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3350 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3352 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3353 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3354 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3360 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3361 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3364 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3366 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3368 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3370 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3371 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3372 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3373 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3374 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3375 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3376 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3379 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3380 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3381 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3382 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3383 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3384 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3385 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3388 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3389 &`auth `& authenticators
3390 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3391 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3392 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3393 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3394 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3395 &`filter `& filter handling
3396 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3397 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3398 &`ident `& ident lookup
3399 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3400 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3401 &`load `& system load checks
3402 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3403 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3404 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3405 &`memory `& memory handling
3406 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3407 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3408 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3409 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3410 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3411 &`retry `& retry handling
3412 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3413 &`route `& address routing
3414 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3416 &`transport `& transports
3417 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3418 &`verify `& address verification logic
3419 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3421 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3422 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3423 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3424 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3425 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3426 turn everything off.
3428 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3429 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3430 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3431 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3432 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3435 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3436 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3437 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3438 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3439 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3442 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3443 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3446 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3447 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3449 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3451 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3452 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3453 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3454 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3457 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3458 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3459 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3460 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3464 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3465 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3466 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3467 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3468 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3469 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3470 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3471 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3474 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3475 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3476 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3477 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3478 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3480 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3482 .cindex "sender" "name"
3483 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3484 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3485 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3486 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3487 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3488 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3490 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3492 .cindex "sender" "address"
3493 .cindex "address" "sender"
3494 .cindex "trusted users"
3495 .cindex "envelope sender"
3496 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3497 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3498 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3499 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3502 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3503 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3504 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3505 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3508 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3509 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3510 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3511 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3512 examples of shell commands:
3514 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3515 exim -f "" user@domain
3517 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3518 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3521 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3522 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3523 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3524 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3527 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3528 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3529 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3530 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3531 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3532 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3536 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3537 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3539 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3541 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3542 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3543 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3548 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3549 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3550 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3551 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3552 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3553 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3555 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3557 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3558 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3559 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3560 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3561 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3562 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3563 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3566 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3567 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3568 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3569 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3570 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3571 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3573 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3574 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3575 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3576 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3578 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3580 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3581 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3582 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3583 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3584 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3585 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3586 can be used only by an admin user.
3588 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3589 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3591 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3592 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3593 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3594 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3595 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3596 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3597 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3598 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3602 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3603 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3604 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3608 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3609 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3610 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3612 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3614 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3615 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3616 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3617 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3618 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3619 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3623 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3624 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3625 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3630 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3631 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3632 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3634 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3636 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3637 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3638 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3639 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3640 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3641 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3642 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3643 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3644 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3645 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3646 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3647 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3648 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3650 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3652 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3653 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3654 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3655 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3656 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3657 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3658 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3659 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3661 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3663 .cindex "freezing messages"
3664 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3665 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3666 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3667 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3668 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3669 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3672 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3674 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3675 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3676 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3677 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3678 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3679 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3680 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3681 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3684 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3686 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3687 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3688 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3689 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3690 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3692 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3694 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3695 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3696 .cindex "removing recipients"
3697 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3698 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3699 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3700 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3701 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3702 can be used only by an admin user.
3704 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3706 .cindex "removing messages"
3707 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3708 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3709 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3710 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3711 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3712 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3713 placed on the queue.
3715 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3717 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3718 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3719 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3720 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3721 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3722 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3723 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3724 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3725 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3727 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3729 .cindex "thawing messages"
3730 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3731 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3732 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3733 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3734 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3735 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3738 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3740 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3741 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3742 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3743 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3745 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3747 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3748 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3749 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3750 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3751 only by an admin user.
3753 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3755 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3756 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3757 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3758 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3759 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3761 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3763 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3764 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3765 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3766 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3770 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3771 treats it that way too.
3775 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3776 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3777 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3778 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3779 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3780 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3781 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3784 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3785 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3786 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3787 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3788 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3789 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3790 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3795 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3796 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3799 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3801 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3804 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3806 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3807 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3808 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3811 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3813 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3814 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3815 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3816 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3817 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3818 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3822 .cindex "background delivery"
3823 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3824 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3825 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3826 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3827 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3828 processes to finish.
3830 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3831 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3832 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3833 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3835 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3836 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3837 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3838 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3842 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3843 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3844 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3845 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3846 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3847 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3849 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3850 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3853 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3854 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3856 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3857 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3858 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3859 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3864 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3869 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3870 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3871 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3872 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3873 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3874 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3875 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3876 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3877 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3878 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3883 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3884 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3885 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3886 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3887 configuration file is in effect.
3889 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3890 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3891 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3892 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3893 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3894 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3895 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3896 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3897 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3902 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3903 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3904 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3907 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3909 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3910 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3911 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3912 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3916 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3917 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3918 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3919 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3920 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3924 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3925 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3926 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3927 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3928 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3932 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3933 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3938 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3939 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3944 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3945 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3946 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3947 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3948 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3949 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3952 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3953 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3955 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3957 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3958 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3959 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3960 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3961 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3962 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3964 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3965 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3967 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3969 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3970 followed by a colon and the port number:
3972 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3974 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3975 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3976 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3977 whichever one is last.
3979 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3981 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3982 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3983 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3984 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3985 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3986 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3988 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3990 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3991 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3992 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3993 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
3994 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
3995 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
3997 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
3999 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4000 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4001 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4002 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4003 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4004 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4005 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4006 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4008 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4010 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4011 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4012 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4013 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4014 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4016 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4018 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4019 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4020 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4021 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4022 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4023 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4024 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4025 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4026 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4029 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4031 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4032 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4033 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4034 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4035 uses the name it is given.
4037 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4039 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4040 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4041 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4042 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4043 used, when there is no default.
4047 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4048 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4049 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4050 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4054 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4055 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4056 whatever that means.
4058 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4060 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4061 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4062 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4063 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4064 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4065 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4066 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4068 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4070 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4071 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4072 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4073 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4074 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4076 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4078 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4079 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4080 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4081 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4082 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4083 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4087 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4089 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4091 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4092 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4093 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4094 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4095 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4096 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4097 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4098 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4102 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4103 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4104 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4105 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4110 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4111 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4112 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4113 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4116 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4118 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4120 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4122 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4123 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4124 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4125 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4126 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4130 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4131 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4132 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4133 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4134 and &%-S%& options).
4136 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4137 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4138 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4139 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4140 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4141 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4144 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4145 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4146 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4147 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4148 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4151 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4152 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4153 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4154 this to be repeated periodically.
4156 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4157 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4158 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4159 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4161 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4162 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4163 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4165 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4166 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4167 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4168 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4172 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4173 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4174 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4175 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4176 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4177 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4180 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4181 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4182 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4183 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4184 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4185 delivered down a single SMTP
4186 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4187 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4188 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4189 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4190 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4193 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4195 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4196 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4197 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4198 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4199 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4201 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4203 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4204 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4205 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4206 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4207 their retry times are tried.
4209 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4211 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4212 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4215 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4217 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4218 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4219 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4222 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4223 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4224 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4225 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4226 starting message id. For example:
4228 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4230 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4231 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4232 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4234 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4236 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4237 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4238 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4239 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4240 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4241 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4243 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4244 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4245 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4246 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4247 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4248 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4249 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4250 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4251 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4253 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4255 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4256 process every 30 minutes.
4258 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4259 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4261 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4263 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4266 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4268 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4270 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4272 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4273 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4274 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4275 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4276 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4277 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4278 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4280 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4281 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4282 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4283 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4284 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4285 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4287 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4288 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4290 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4292 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4293 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4294 applied to each queue run.
4296 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4297 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4298 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4299 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4300 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4301 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4302 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4303 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4304 address will be skipped.
4306 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4307 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4308 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4311 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4312 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4313 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4314 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4315 an arbitrary command instead.
4319 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4321 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4323 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4324 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4325 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4326 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4327 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4328 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4330 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4332 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4333 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4334 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4338 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4339 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4340 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4341 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4342 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4343 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4344 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4345 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4346 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4348 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4349 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4350 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4351 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4352 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4353 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4354 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4355 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4356 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4357 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4358 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4360 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4361 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4362 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4363 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4364 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4365 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4367 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4368 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4369 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4370 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4371 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4372 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4373 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4374 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4375 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4379 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4380 compatibility with Sendmail.
4382 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4383 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4384 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4385 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4386 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4387 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4388 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4389 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4394 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4395 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4396 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4397 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4398 set. Exim ignores this option.
4402 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4403 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4404 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4405 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4406 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4407 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4412 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4413 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4414 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4423 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4424 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4425 . creates a man page for the options.
4426 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4429 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4440 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4441 "The runtime configuration file"
4443 .cindex "run time configuration"
4444 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4445 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4446 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4447 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4448 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4449 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4450 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4451 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4454 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4455 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4456 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4457 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4458 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4459 actually alter the string.
4461 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4462 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4463 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4464 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4465 existing file in the list.
4468 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4469 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4470 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4471 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4472 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4473 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4474 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4475 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4476 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4477 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4478 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4480 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4481 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4482 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4483 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4484 configuration is not group writeable.
4486 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4487 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4488 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4489 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4490 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4491 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4496 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4497 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4498 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4499 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4500 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4501 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4502 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4503 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4504 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4506 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4507 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4508 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4509 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4510 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4511 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4512 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4513 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4514 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4516 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4517 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4518 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4519 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4520 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4522 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4523 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4524 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4525 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4526 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4527 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4529 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4530 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4531 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4532 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4533 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4534 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4535 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4537 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4538 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4539 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4543 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4544 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4545 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4546 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4547 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4548 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4549 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4553 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4556 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4557 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4558 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4560 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4561 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4562 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4564 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4565 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4566 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4568 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4569 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4570 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4571 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4574 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4575 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4576 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4578 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4579 want to use this feature, you must set
4581 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4583 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4584 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4587 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4588 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4589 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4590 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4592 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4593 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4594 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4595 and does not introduce a comment.
4597 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4598 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4599 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4600 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4601 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4603 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4604 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4605 change settings as required.
4607 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4608 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4609 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4610 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4611 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4616 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4617 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4618 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4619 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4620 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4621 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4624 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4625 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4627 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4628 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4629 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4632 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4633 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4634 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4635 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4637 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4638 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4641 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4644 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4645 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4650 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4651 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4652 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4653 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4654 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4655 definition, and must be of the form
4657 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4659 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4660 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4661 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4662 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4663 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4665 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4666 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4667 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4669 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4670 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4671 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4672 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4673 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4674 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4675 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4678 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4679 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4681 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4682 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4683 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4684 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4685 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4686 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4689 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4690 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4691 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4696 MAC == updated value
4698 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4699 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4700 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4701 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4705 MAC == MAC and something added
4707 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4708 from a number of other files.
4710 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4711 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4712 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4713 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4714 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4719 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4720 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4721 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4722 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4724 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4725 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4727 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4729 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4731 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4732 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4733 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4736 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4738 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4739 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4740 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4741 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4742 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4744 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4745 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4746 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4750 message_size_limit = 50M
4752 message_size_limit = 100M
4755 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4756 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4757 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4758 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4760 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4761 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4762 in this line"& will always be true.
4764 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4765 to clarify complicated nestings.
4769 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4770 .cindex "common option syntax"
4771 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4772 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4773 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4774 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4775 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4776 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4777 space) and then the value. For example:
4779 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4781 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4782 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4783 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4784 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4785 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4786 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4787 word &"hide"&. For example:
4789 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4791 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4793 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4795 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4796 all instances of the same driver.
4798 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4799 that are found in option settings.
4802 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4803 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4804 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4805 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4806 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4807 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4808 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4809 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4810 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4811 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4812 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4813 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4818 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4823 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4828 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4829 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4830 .cindex "format" "integer"
4831 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4832 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4833 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4834 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4837 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4838 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4839 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4840 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4841 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4845 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4846 .cindex "integer format"
4847 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4848 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4849 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4850 Such options are always output in octal.
4853 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4854 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4855 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4856 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4857 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4861 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4862 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4863 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4864 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4865 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4875 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4876 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4877 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4881 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4882 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4883 .cindex "format" "string"
4884 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4885 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4886 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4887 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4888 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4889 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4890 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4891 therefore equivalent:
4893 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4894 trusted_users = uucp:\
4895 # This comment line is ignored
4898 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4899 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4900 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4901 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4902 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4905 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4906 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4907 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4909 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4910 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4914 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4915 character, that character replaces the pair.
4917 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4918 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4919 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4920 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4921 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4922 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4925 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4926 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4927 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4928 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4929 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4930 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4931 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4932 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4933 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4934 within a quoted configuration string.
4937 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4938 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4939 .cindex "format" "user name"
4940 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4941 .cindex "format" "group name"
4942 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4943 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4944 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4945 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4948 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4949 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4950 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4951 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4952 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4953 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4954 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4955 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4956 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4957 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4958 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4960 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4961 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4962 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4963 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4964 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4965 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4968 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4970 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4972 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4973 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4974 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4975 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4977 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4978 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4979 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4980 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4981 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4982 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4983 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4984 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4986 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4988 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4989 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4990 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4992 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4993 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
4994 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
4995 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
4996 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
4997 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
4998 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
4999 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5000 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5002 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5004 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5005 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5006 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5007 the value in quotes. For example:
5009 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5011 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5012 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5013 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5014 enclosing an empty list item.
5018 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5019 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5020 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5021 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5023 senders = user@domain :
5025 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5026 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5027 items, the second of which is empty:
5029 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5031 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5032 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5033 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5034 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5038 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5039 is at the end of the list.
5044 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5045 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5046 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5047 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5048 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5049 a sequence of lines like this:
5051 <&'instance name'&>:
5056 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5057 followed by three options settings:
5062 transport = local_delivery
5064 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5065 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5066 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5067 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5068 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5069 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5071 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5072 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5074 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5075 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5076 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5077 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5078 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5081 .cindex "generic options"
5082 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5083 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5084 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5085 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5086 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5087 .cindex "private options"
5088 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5089 they all have default values.
5091 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5092 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5093 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5095 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5096 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5097 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5098 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5099 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5100 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5101 configuration lines:
5106 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5107 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5108 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5109 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5115 command_timeout = 10s
5117 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5118 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5121 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5122 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5123 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5134 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5135 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5136 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5137 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5138 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5139 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5140 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5141 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5142 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5143 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5144 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5148 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5149 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5150 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5153 # primary_hostname =
5155 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5156 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5157 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5158 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5160 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5162 domainlist local_domains = @
5163 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5164 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5166 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5167 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5168 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5169 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5171 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5172 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5175 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5176 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5177 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5178 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5179 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5180 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5182 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5183 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5184 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5185 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5186 domain is permitted.
5188 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5189 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5190 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5191 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5192 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5193 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5195 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5196 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5197 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5199 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5201 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5202 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5204 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5205 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5206 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5207 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5208 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5209 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5210 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5211 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5212 contents of a message to be checked.
5214 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5216 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5217 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5219 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5220 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5221 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5222 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5224 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5226 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5227 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5228 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5230 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5231 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5232 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5233 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5234 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5235 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5236 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5238 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5240 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5241 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5243 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5244 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5245 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5246 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5247 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5248 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5249 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5250 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5251 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5252 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5253 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5254 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5255 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5256 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5257 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5258 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5260 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5263 # qualify_recipient =
5265 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5266 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5267 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5268 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5269 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5270 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5272 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5273 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5274 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5275 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5277 # allow_domain_literals
5279 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5280 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5281 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5282 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5283 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5284 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5286 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5290 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5291 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5292 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5293 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5294 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5295 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5296 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5297 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5299 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5300 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5305 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5306 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5307 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5308 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5309 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5310 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5313 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5314 1413 (hence their names):
5317 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5319 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5320 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5321 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5322 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5323 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5324 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5325 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5327 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5328 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5329 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5330 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5332 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5333 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5335 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5336 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5338 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5340 # percent_hack_domains =
5342 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5343 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5344 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5346 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5347 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5348 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5349 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5350 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5351 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5352 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5353 always bounce messages.
5355 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5356 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5358 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5359 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5360 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5361 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5362 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5366 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5367 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5368 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5369 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5370 It starts with the line
5374 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5375 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5376 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5378 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5379 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5380 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5381 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5382 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5383 result of the ACL processing.
5387 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5392 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5393 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5394 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5395 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5396 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5397 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5399 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5400 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5401 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5404 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5405 domains = +local_domains
5406 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5408 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5409 domains = !+local_domains
5410 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5412 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5413 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5414 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5415 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5416 in Internet mail addresses.
5418 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5419 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5420 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5421 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5422 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5423 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5424 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5425 policy of being as safe as possible.
5427 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5428 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5429 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5430 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5431 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5432 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5434 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5435 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5436 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5437 have to modify this rule.
5439 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5440 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5441 common convention of local parts constructed as
5442 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5443 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5444 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5445 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5446 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5447 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5449 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5450 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5451 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5452 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5453 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5454 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5455 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5457 accept local_parts = postmaster
5458 domains = +local_domains
5460 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5461 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5462 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5463 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5464 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5466 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5467 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5468 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5470 require verify = sender
5472 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5473 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5474 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5475 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5476 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5477 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5478 discusses the details of address verification.
5480 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5481 control = submission
5483 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5484 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5485 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5486 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5487 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5488 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5489 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5490 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5491 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5493 accept authenticated = *
5494 control = submission
5496 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5497 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5498 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5499 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5500 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5501 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5503 require message = relay not permitted
5504 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5506 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5507 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5509 require verify = recipient
5511 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5512 fails, the address is rejected.
5514 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5515 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5517 # dnslists = black.list.example
5519 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5520 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5521 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5522 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5524 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5525 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5526 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5529 # require verify = csa
5531 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5532 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5537 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5538 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5542 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5543 of this ACL are commented out:
5546 # message = This message contains a virus \
5549 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5550 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5551 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5552 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5554 # warn spam = nobody
5555 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5556 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5557 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5558 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5560 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5561 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5562 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5563 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5564 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5565 whatever the spam score.
5569 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5572 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5573 .cindex "default" "routers"
5574 .cindex "routers" "default"
5575 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5580 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5581 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5582 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5583 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5584 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5587 # driver = ipliteral
5588 # domains = !+local_domains
5589 # transport = remote_smtp
5591 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5592 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5593 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5594 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5595 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5599 domains = ! +local_domains
5600 transport = remote_smtp
5601 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5604 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5605 domains. This is specified by the line
5607 domains = ! +local_domains
5609 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5610 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5611 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5612 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5613 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5614 passed on to the following routers.
5616 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5617 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5618 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5619 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5620 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5622 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5623 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5624 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5625 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5626 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5627 the address fails and is bounced.
5629 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5630 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5631 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5632 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5633 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5634 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5635 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5642 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5644 file_transport = address_file
5645 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5647 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5648 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5649 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5650 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5651 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5654 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5655 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5656 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5657 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5662 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5663 # local_part_suffix_optional
5664 file = $home/.forward
5669 file_transport = address_file
5670 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5671 reply_transport = address_reply
5673 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5674 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5675 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5676 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5677 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5680 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5681 # local_part_suffix_optional
5683 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5684 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5685 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5686 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5687 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5688 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5689 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5691 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5692 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5693 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5694 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5696 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5697 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5698 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5699 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5700 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5701 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5702 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5704 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5705 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5706 There are two reasons for doing this:
5709 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5710 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5713 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5714 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5715 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5716 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5720 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5721 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5722 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5723 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5725 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5726 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5727 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5729 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5731 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5737 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5738 # local_part_suffix_optional
5739 transport = local_delivery
5741 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5742 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5743 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5744 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5745 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5748 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5749 .cindex "default" "transports"
5750 .cindex "transports" "default"
5751 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5752 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5753 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5757 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5762 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5763 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5767 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5774 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5775 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5776 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5777 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5778 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5779 show how this can be done.
5781 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5782 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5783 similarly-named options above.
5789 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5790 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5791 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5800 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5801 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5802 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5807 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5812 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5813 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5814 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5815 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5816 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5817 introduced by the line
5821 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5824 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5826 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5827 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5828 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5829 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5831 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5832 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5833 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5836 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5837 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5841 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5842 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5846 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5847 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5848 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5850 begin authenticators
5852 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5853 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5854 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5855 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5856 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5857 to support most MUA software.
5859 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5862 # driver = plaintext
5863 # server_set_id = $auth2
5864 # server_prompts = :
5865 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5866 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5868 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5871 # driver = plaintext
5872 # server_set_id = $auth1
5873 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5874 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5875 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5878 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5879 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5880 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5881 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5882 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5883 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5884 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5885 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5887 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5888 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5889 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5890 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5892 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5899 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5901 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5903 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5904 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5905 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5906 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5907 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5908 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5910 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5911 are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5912 &_doc/pcrepattern.txt_& in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5913 tarbundle of Exim documentation. It describes in detail the features of the
5914 regular expressions that PCRE supports, so no further description is included
5915 here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using the default option settings
5916 (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that the PCRE_CASELESS option is
5917 set when the matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5919 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5920 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5921 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5922 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5924 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5926 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5927 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5928 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5929 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5930 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5931 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5934 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5935 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5936 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5937 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5938 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5939 match anywhere in the subject string.
5941 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5942 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5944 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5946 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5949 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5951 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5952 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5956 .section "Testing regular expressions" "SECID59"
5957 .cindex "testing" "regular expressions"
5958 .cindex "regular expressions" "testing"
5959 .cindex "&'pcretest'&"
5960 A program called &'pcretest'& forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5961 with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5962 testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5963 expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5964 directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5965 of various options in &_doc/pcretest.txt_&, but for simple testing, none are
5966 needed. This is the output of a sample run of &'pcretest'&:
5968 &` re> `&&*&`/^([@]+)@.+\.(ac|edu)\.(?!kr)[a-z]{2}$/`&*&
5969 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.uk`&*&
5973 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.kr`&*&
5975 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.com`&*&
5977 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.co`&*&
5982 Input typed by the user is shown in bold face. After the &"re>"& prompt, a
5983 regular expression enclosed in delimiters is expected. If this compiles without
5984 error, &"data>"& prompts are given for strings against which the expression is
5985 matched. An empty data line causes a new regular expression to be read. If the
5986 match is successful, the captured substring values (that is, what would be in
5987 the variables &$0$&, &$1$&, &$2$&, etc.) are shown. The above example tests for
5988 an email address whose domain ends with either &"ac"& or &"edu"& followed by a
5989 two-character top-level domain that is not &"kr"&. The local part is captured
5990 in &$1$& and the &"ac"& or &"edu"& in &$2$&.
5997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6000 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6001 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6002 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6003 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6004 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6005 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6008 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6009 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6010 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6011 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6012 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6014 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6015 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6016 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6017 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6018 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6021 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6022 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6023 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6024 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6025 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6026 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6028 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6029 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6030 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6031 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6032 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6034 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6035 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6037 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6038 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6039 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6040 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6041 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6043 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6044 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6046 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6047 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6049 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6050 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6051 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6056 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6057 matches the list item.
6059 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6060 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6062 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6064 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6065 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6066 causes a second lookup to occur.
6068 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6069 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6070 lookup is permitted.
6073 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6074 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6075 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6076 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6079 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6080 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6081 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6083 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6084 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6085 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6086 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6089 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6090 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6091 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6096 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6097 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6098 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6103 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6104 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6105 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6106 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6109 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6110 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6111 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6112 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6113 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6114 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6115 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6116 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6117 be found in several places:
6119 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6120 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6121 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6123 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6124 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6125 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6126 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6128 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6129 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6130 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6131 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6132 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6133 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6134 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6136 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6137 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6138 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6139 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6140 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6141 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6142 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6144 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6145 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6146 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6148 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6149 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6150 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6151 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6152 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6153 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6154 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6155 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6156 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6157 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6159 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6160 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6161 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6162 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6163 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6164 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6165 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6166 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6167 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6169 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6170 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6171 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6172 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6173 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6174 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6175 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6177 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6178 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
6179 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6180 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6182 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6183 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6184 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6185 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6186 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6188 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6189 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6190 lookup types support only literal keys.
6192 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6193 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6194 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6196 .cindex "linear search"
6197 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6198 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6199 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6200 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6201 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6202 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6203 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6204 in the file is used.
6206 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6207 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6208 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6209 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6210 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6215 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6216 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6217 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6218 wildcarding of any kind.
6220 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6221 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6222 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6223 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6224 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6225 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6226 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6227 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6228 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6231 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6232 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6233 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6234 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6235 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6236 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6237 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6238 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6241 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6242 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6243 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6244 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6245 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6246 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6247 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6248 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6249 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6251 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6252 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6253 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6254 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6256 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6257 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6260 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6262 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6263 *fish data for anythingfish
6266 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6267 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6269 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6271 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6272 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6273 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6275 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6277 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6278 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6279 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6281 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6284 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6285 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6286 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6287 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6288 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6290 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6291 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6292 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6293 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6294 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6297 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6298 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6299 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6302 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6304 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6307 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6308 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6309 be followed by optional colons.
6311 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6312 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6313 lookup types support only literal keys.
6317 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6318 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6319 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6320 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6321 many of them are given in later sections.
6324 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6325 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6326 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6327 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6328 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6330 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6331 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6332 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6334 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6335 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6336 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6337 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6338 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6339 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6340 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6342 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6343 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6344 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6345 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6347 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6349 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6350 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6352 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6353 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6354 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6355 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6357 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6358 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6359 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6360 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6361 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6362 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6363 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6364 password value. For example:
6366 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6369 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6371 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6372 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6375 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6376 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6377 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6378 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6381 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6382 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6384 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6385 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6386 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6387 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6388 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6389 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6390 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6391 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6392 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6394 require condition = \
6395 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6397 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6398 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6399 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6400 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6405 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6406 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6407 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6408 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6409 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6410 options such as a list of local domains.
6412 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6413 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6414 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6415 or may give up altogether.
6419 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6420 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6421 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6422 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6423 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6424 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6425 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6426 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6428 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6429 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6430 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6432 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6433 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6434 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6436 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6437 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6438 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6439 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6440 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6441 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6442 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6443 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6444 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6445 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6447 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6449 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6450 looks up these keys, in this order:
6456 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6457 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6458 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6459 Exim move on to try the next key.
6463 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6464 .cindex "partial matching"
6465 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6466 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6467 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6468 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6469 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6470 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6471 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6472 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6473 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6474 a key in a DBM file is
6476 *.dates.fict.example
6478 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6479 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6480 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6483 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6484 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6485 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6487 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6488 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6489 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6490 partial matching keys
6491 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6492 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6493 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6495 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6496 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6497 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6498 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6499 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6500 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6503 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6504 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6505 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6506 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6507 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6508 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6510 2250.dates.fict.example
6511 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6512 *.dates.fict.example
6515 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6518 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6519 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6520 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6521 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6522 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6523 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6525 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6527 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6528 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6529 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6530 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6532 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6534 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6535 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6537 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6538 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6539 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6542 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6544 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6545 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6547 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6548 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6549 for &"*"& on its own.
6551 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6555 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6556 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6557 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6558 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6559 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6560 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6561 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6563 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6564 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6565 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6566 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6567 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6572 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6573 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6574 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6575 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6576 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6577 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6578 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6580 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6581 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6582 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6583 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6584 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6585 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6587 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6588 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6594 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6595 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6596 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6597 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6598 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6599 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6603 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6604 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6606 [name="$local_part"]
6608 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6609 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6610 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6611 of the following form is provided:
6613 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6615 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6617 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6619 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6620 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6621 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6626 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6627 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6628 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6629 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6630 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6631 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6632 an expansion string could contain:
6634 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6636 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6637 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6638 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6639 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6641 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6642 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6643 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6644 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6645 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6647 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6649 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6650 altered and nothing is added.
6652 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6653 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6654 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6655 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6656 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6658 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6659 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6660 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6661 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6662 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6663 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6665 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6667 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6668 white space is ignored.
6670 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6671 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6672 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6673 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6674 the pseudo-type MXH:
6676 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6678 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6681 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6682 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6683 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6684 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6685 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6686 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6687 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6688 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6690 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6691 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6693 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6694 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6695 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6697 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6698 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6699 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6700 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6701 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6704 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6705 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6706 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6707 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6708 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6709 result of a successful lookup such as:
6711 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6713 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6714 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6715 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6718 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6719 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6720 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6721 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6722 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6724 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6725 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6726 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6728 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6729 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6730 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6731 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6733 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6734 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6735 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6737 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6738 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6739 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6740 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6741 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6742 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6743 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6744 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6745 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6746 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6748 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6749 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6751 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6752 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6757 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6758 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6760 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6761 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6762 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6763 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6764 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6765 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6766 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6767 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6768 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6770 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6771 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6772 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6773 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6774 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6776 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6777 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6779 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6780 the way they handle the results of a query:
6783 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6786 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6787 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6789 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6790 from all of them are returned.
6794 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6795 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6796 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6797 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6800 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6801 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6802 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6803 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6805 data = ${lookup ldap \
6806 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6807 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6809 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6810 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6811 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6812 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6815 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6816 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6817 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6818 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6819 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6820 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6822 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6823 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6831 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6832 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6836 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6838 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6842 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6844 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6846 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6848 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6849 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6850 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6854 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6855 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6856 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6858 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6862 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6864 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6866 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6868 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6869 authentication below.
6872 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6873 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6874 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6875 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6876 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6879 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6881 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6882 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6883 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6884 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6885 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6886 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6887 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6888 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6889 failures, and timeouts.
6891 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6892 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6893 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6894 doubled. For example
6896 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6898 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6899 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6900 the local host) is used.
6902 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6903 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6904 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6905 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6908 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6909 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6910 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6911 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6913 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6915 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6916 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6918 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6920 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6921 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6922 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6923 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6924 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6925 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6926 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6929 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6930 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6931 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6934 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6937 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6941 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6942 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6946 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6947 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6948 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6949 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6950 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6951 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6952 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6953 them. The following names are recognized:
6955 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6956 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6957 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6958 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6959 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6960 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6961 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6963 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6964 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6965 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6966 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6968 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6969 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6970 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6971 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6972 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6973 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6974 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6975 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6976 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6978 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6979 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6982 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6983 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6986 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6987 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6990 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6991 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6992 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6993 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6995 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6996 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6997 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6999 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7000 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7001 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7002 quoting has two advantages:
7005 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7006 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7008 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7011 For example, a setting such as
7013 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7015 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7017 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7018 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7019 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7020 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7024 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7025 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7030 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7031 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7032 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7033 as a sequence of values, for example
7035 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7037 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7038 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7039 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7040 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7041 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7044 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7045 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7046 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7048 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7049 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7050 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7051 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7052 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7053 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7054 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7056 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7057 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7058 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7060 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7063 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7066 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7067 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7069 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7070 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7072 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7073 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7074 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7075 results of LDAP lookups.
7080 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7081 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7082 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7083 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7084 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7085 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7086 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7087 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7089 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7091 might return the string
7093 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7094 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7096 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7098 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7104 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7105 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7106 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7110 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7111 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7112 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7113 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7114 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7115 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7116 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7117 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7118 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7119 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7120 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7121 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7124 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7127 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7128 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7130 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7135 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7137 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7138 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7139 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7143 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7144 with a newline between the data for each row.
7147 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7148 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7149 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7151 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7152 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7153 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7154 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7155 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7156 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7157 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7158 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7160 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7161 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7162 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7163 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7164 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7165 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7167 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7169 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7170 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7171 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7173 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7174 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7176 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7177 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7178 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7179 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7180 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7181 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7183 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7184 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7185 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7186 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7187 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7188 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7189 characters are not special.
7191 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7192 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7193 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7194 done by starting the query with
7196 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7198 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7200 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7201 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7202 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7205 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7207 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7208 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7209 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7211 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7212 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7213 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7216 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7220 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7222 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...}
7224 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7225 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7226 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7228 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...}
7232 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7233 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7234 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7235 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7236 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7238 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7239 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7241 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7242 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7244 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7247 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7248 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7250 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7251 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7252 is zero because no rows are affected.
7255 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7256 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7257 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7258 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7259 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7262 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7264 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7265 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7266 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7268 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7269 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7272 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7273 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7274 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7275 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7276 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7277 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7278 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7279 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7280 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7282 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7283 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7285 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7287 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7288 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7290 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7291 quote, which it doubles.
7293 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7294 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7295 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7296 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7297 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7298 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7307 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7308 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7309 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7310 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7311 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7312 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7313 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7314 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7315 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7317 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7318 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7319 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7320 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7324 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7325 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7326 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7327 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7328 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7329 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7330 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7331 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7334 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7335 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7336 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7338 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7339 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7340 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7341 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7342 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7344 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7345 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7347 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7348 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7349 senders based on the receiving domain.
7354 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7355 .cindex "list" "negation"
7356 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7357 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7358 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7359 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7360 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7361 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7363 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7364 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7365 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7366 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7367 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7369 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7371 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7372 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7373 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7375 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7377 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7378 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7379 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7381 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7382 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7387 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7388 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7389 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7390 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7391 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7392 file names are not allowed,
7393 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7394 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7398 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7399 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7401 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7402 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7403 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7405 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7409 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7410 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7411 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7412 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7414 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7415 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7417 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7419 and the file contains the lines
7424 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7425 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7429 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7430 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7431 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7432 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7433 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7434 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7435 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7436 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7438 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7439 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7440 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7441 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7446 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7447 .cindex "named lists"
7448 .cindex "list" "named"
7449 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7450 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7451 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7452 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7453 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7454 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7455 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7457 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7459 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7460 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7461 configured with the line
7463 domains = +local_domains
7465 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7466 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7470 domains = ! +local_domains
7471 transport = remote_smtp
7474 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7475 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7476 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7477 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7479 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7480 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7482 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7484 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7485 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7486 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7488 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7489 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7490 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7492 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7493 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7495 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7496 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7497 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7499 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7501 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7502 referenced lists if you can.
7504 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7505 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7506 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7508 domains = +local_domains
7510 on several of your routers
7511 or in several ACL statements,
7512 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7513 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7514 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7515 the same each time they are referenced.
7517 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7518 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7519 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7520 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7524 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7525 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7526 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7527 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7528 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7531 ALIST = host1 : host2
7532 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7534 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7536 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7538 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7541 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7542 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7544 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7546 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7550 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7551 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7552 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7553 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7554 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7555 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7556 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7557 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7558 message. For example:
7560 domainlist special_domains = \
7561 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7563 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7564 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7565 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7566 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7567 same list each time.
7569 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7570 cache the result anyway. For example:
7572 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7574 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7575 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7579 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7580 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7581 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7582 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7583 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7586 .cindex "primary host name"
7587 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7588 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7589 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7590 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7591 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7592 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7593 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7594 differ only in their names.
7596 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7597 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7598 .cindex "domain literal"
7599 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7600 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7601 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7602 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7603 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7604 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7607 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7608 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7609 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7610 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7611 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7612 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7613 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7614 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7615 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7616 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7617 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7619 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7620 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7621 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7622 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7623 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7625 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7626 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7627 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7628 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7629 on a router). For example:
7631 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7633 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7634 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7636 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7637 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7638 contain negative items.
7640 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7641 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7642 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7644 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7645 an.other.domain : ...
7647 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7648 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7650 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7651 an.other.domain ? ...
7654 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7655 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7656 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7657 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7658 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7659 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7660 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7661 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7662 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7666 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7667 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7668 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7669 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7670 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7671 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7672 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7673 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7674 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7676 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7677 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7678 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7679 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7680 expression by expansion, of course).
7682 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7683 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7684 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7685 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7686 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7687 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7689 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7691 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7692 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7693 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7694 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7695 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7696 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7697 other statements in the same ACL.
7700 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7701 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7703 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7705 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7706 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7709 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7710 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7711 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7712 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7713 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7714 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7717 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7718 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7719 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7720 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7722 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7723 where domain = '$domain';
7725 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7726 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7727 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7728 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7729 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7731 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7732 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7733 between the pattern and the domain.
7736 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7738 domainlist funny_domains = \
7741 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7742 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7743 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7744 nis;domains.byname : \
7745 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7747 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7748 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7749 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7750 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7751 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7756 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7757 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7758 .cindex "list" "host list"
7759 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7760 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7761 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7762 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7763 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7764 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7765 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7768 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7769 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7770 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7771 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7772 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7773 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7776 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7777 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7778 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7782 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7783 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7784 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7785 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7786 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7787 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7788 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7791 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7792 inspecting its IP address:
7795 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7796 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7797 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7798 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7799 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7800 with the IP address of the subject host.
7802 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7803 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7804 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7805 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7806 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7809 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7810 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7811 domain name, as just described.
7814 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7815 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7816 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7817 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7818 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7819 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7820 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7821 that can never match a client host.
7824 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7825 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7826 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7827 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7829 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7833 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7834 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7835 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7836 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7837 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7838 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7839 significant end of the address.
7841 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7842 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7843 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7844 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7848 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7849 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7852 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7854 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7855 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7857 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7858 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7861 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7863 could make use of a file containing
7868 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7869 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7870 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7872 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7875 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7881 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7882 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7883 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7884 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7885 address, the pattern takes this form:
7887 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7891 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7893 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7894 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7895 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7896 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7897 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7898 returned by the lookup is not used.
7900 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7901 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7902 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7903 patterns of this form:
7905 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7909 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7911 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7912 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7913 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7914 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7915 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7917 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7918 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7919 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7920 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7921 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7922 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7923 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7924 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7925 addresses are always used.
7927 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7928 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7929 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7932 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7933 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7934 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7935 case the IP address is used on its own.
7939 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7940 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7941 .cindex "unknown host name"
7942 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7943 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7944 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7945 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7946 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7949 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7950 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7951 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7952 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7953 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7954 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7955 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7957 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7958 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7960 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7961 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7962 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7963 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7964 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7965 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7966 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7967 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7968 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7970 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7971 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7973 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7974 .cindex "alias for host"
7975 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7976 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7979 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7980 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7981 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7982 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7983 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7986 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7987 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7988 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7989 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7990 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7991 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7992 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7997 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7998 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7999 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8000 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8001 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8003 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8005 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8006 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8007 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8014 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8015 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8016 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8017 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8018 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8019 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8021 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8022 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8024 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8025 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8026 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8027 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8028 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8029 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8032 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8033 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8035 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8037 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8038 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8041 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8042 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8045 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8048 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8049 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8050 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8053 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8054 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8058 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8060 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8061 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8062 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8063 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8064 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8065 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8066 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8067 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8068 host lists such as whitelists.
8072 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8073 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8074 .cindex "unknown host name"
8075 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8076 If a pattern is of the form
8078 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8082 dbm;/host/accept/list
8084 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8085 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8088 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8089 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8090 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8091 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8092 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8093 lookup, both using the same file.
8097 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8098 If a pattern is of the form
8100 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8102 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8103 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8104 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8106 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8107 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8109 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8110 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8111 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8114 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8115 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8116 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8118 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8119 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8120 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8121 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8122 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8123 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8127 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8129 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8130 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8131 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8134 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8136 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8137 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8138 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8139 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8140 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8141 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8143 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8144 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8146 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8147 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8149 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8150 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8156 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8157 .cindex "list" "address list"
8158 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8159 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8160 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8161 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8162 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8163 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8164 using this option setting:
8168 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8169 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8170 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8171 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8173 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8176 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8178 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8179 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8180 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8181 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8182 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8183 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8184 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8186 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8187 *@+hostile_domains:\
8188 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8189 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8191 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8192 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8193 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8194 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8195 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8197 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8198 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8199 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8200 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8201 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8203 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8206 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8207 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8211 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8212 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8213 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8214 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8215 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8216 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8217 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8219 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8220 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8222 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8223 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8226 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8227 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8228 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8231 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8232 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8233 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8235 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8236 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8237 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8238 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8240 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8241 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8243 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8244 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8245 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8246 default. For example, with this lookup:
8248 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8250 the file could contains lines like this:
8252 user1@domain1.example
8255 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8258 nimrod@jaeger.example
8262 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8263 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8265 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8267 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8268 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8270 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8271 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8272 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8276 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8277 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8282 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8283 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8284 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8285 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8286 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8287 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8288 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8289 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8290 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8292 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8293 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8294 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8295 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8296 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8299 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8301 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8303 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8305 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8307 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8308 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8309 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8310 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8311 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8312 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8314 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8317 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8320 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8321 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8322 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8323 might have entries like
8325 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8326 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8329 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8330 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8331 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8332 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8334 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8335 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8336 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8339 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8340 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8341 can only return a single list of local parts.
8344 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8345 in these two examples:
8348 senders = *@+my_list
8350 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8351 example it is a named domain list.
8356 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8357 .cindex "case of local parts"
8358 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8359 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8360 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8361 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8362 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8363 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8364 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8365 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8368 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8369 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8370 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8371 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8372 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8373 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8374 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8377 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8378 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8379 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8380 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8381 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8382 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8383 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8384 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8388 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8389 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8390 .cindex "local part" "list"
8391 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8392 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8393 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8394 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8395 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8396 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8397 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8398 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8400 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8401 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8402 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8403 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8404 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8405 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8406 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8408 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8416 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8417 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8418 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8419 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8421 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8422 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8423 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8424 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8425 escape character, as described in the following section.
8429 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8430 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8431 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8432 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8433 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8434 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8435 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8436 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8438 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8439 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8440 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8441 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8443 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8445 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8446 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8451 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8452 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8453 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8454 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8455 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8456 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8457 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8460 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8461 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8462 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8465 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8466 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8467 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8469 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8470 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8471 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8472 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8473 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8474 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8475 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8478 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8479 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8480 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8483 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8484 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8485 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8486 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8488 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8490 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8491 Exim message identifier. For example:
8493 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8495 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8496 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8499 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8500 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8501 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8502 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8503 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8504 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8505 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8506 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8507 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8508 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8509 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8510 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8516 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8517 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8518 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8519 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8520 white space is significant.
8523 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8524 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8525 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8530 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8531 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8532 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8533 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8534 given, the expansion fails.
8536 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8537 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8538 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8539 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8543 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8544 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8545 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8546 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8547 string easier to understand.
8549 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8550 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8551 expansion item below.
8553 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8554 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8556 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8557 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8561 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8562 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8563 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8565 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8566 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8567 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8568 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8569 must have the following type:
8571 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8573 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8574 function should return one of the following values:
8576 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8577 into the expanded string that is being built.
8579 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8580 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8582 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8583 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8585 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8587 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8588 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8589 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8591 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8592 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8593 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8594 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8595 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8596 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8597 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8600 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8603 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8604 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8605 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8606 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8607 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8608 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8609 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8610 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8611 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8613 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8614 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8615 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8618 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8619 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8621 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8622 appear, for example:
8624 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8626 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8627 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8630 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8631 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8632 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8633 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8634 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8635 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8636 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8637 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8638 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8639 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8640 <&'string3'&> as before.
8642 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8643 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8644 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8645 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8646 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8647 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8648 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8649 provided. For example:
8651 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8655 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8657 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8658 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8661 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8662 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8663 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8665 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8666 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8667 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8668 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8669 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8670 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8671 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8673 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8675 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8676 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8679 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8680 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8681 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8682 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8683 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8684 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8686 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8687 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8688 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8689 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8691 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8693 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8694 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8695 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8696 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8697 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8699 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8701 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8702 letters appear. For example:
8704 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8705 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8706 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8709 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8710 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8711 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8712 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8713 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8714 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8715 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8716 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8717 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8718 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8719 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8720 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8721 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8722 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8726 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8727 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8728 lines) may be present.
8730 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8731 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8734 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8735 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8736 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8739 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8740 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8741 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8742 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8743 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8744 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8745 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8746 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8749 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8750 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8751 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8752 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8753 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8754 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8757 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8758 command of the following form:
8760 headers charset "UTF-8"
8762 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8763 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8764 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8765 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8766 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8769 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8770 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8771 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8772 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8774 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8775 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8776 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8777 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8778 router or transport are not accessible.
8780 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8781 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8782 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8783 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8784 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8785 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8787 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8788 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8789 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8790 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8791 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8792 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8793 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8795 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8796 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8797 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8798 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8799 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8800 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8801 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8802 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8805 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8806 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8808 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8809 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8810 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8811 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8812 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8813 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8814 present. For example:
8816 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8818 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8821 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8823 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8824 an Exim configuration:
8826 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8828 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8831 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8832 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8833 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8835 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8836 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8837 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8838 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8839 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8840 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8843 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8844 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8845 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8846 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8847 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8848 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8850 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8852 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8853 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8854 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8855 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8856 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8858 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8859 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8860 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8862 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8866 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8869 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8870 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8871 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8872 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8873 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8874 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8875 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8878 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8880 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8881 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8882 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8885 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8886 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8887 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8888 described in the next item.
8890 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8891 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8892 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8893 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8894 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8895 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8896 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8897 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8898 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8900 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8901 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8902 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8903 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8904 out by the system administrator.
8907 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8908 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8909 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8910 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8911 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8912 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8913 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8914 original lookup fails.
8916 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8917 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8918 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8919 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8920 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8921 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8922 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8923 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8925 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8926 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8927 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8928 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8930 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8931 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8932 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8933 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8935 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8937 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8939 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8940 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8942 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8947 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8948 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8950 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8951 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8952 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8953 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8954 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8955 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8957 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8959 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8960 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8961 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8963 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8964 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8965 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8966 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8967 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8968 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8969 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8971 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8973 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8974 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8975 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8976 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8979 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8981 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8985 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8986 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8987 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8988 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8989 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8990 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8991 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8992 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8994 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8995 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8996 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8997 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8998 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9001 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9002 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9003 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9005 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9006 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9009 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9010 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9011 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9012 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9013 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9014 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9015 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9016 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9018 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9019 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9020 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9021 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9022 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9023 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9024 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9025 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9026 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9027 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9029 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9030 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9031 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9032 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9034 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9035 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9036 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9037 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9038 is the expansion of the third argument.
9040 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9041 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9042 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9044 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9045 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9046 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9047 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9048 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9049 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9050 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9051 newlines are left in the string.
9052 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9053 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9054 the string expansion fails.
9056 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9057 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9061 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9062 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9063 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9064 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9065 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9066 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9067 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9070 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9071 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9073 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9074 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9075 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9076 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9077 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9080 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9082 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9083 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9084 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9085 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9086 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9087 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9089 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9091 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9092 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9093 turns them into spaces:
9095 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9097 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9098 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9099 addition, the following errors can occur:
9102 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9104 Failure to connect the socket;
9106 Failure to write the request string;
9108 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9111 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9112 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9113 errors occurs. For example:
9115 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9118 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9119 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9120 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9121 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9122 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9124 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9125 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9128 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9129 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9130 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9133 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9134 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9135 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9136 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9137 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9138 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9139 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9140 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9141 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9143 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9145 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9148 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9150 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9151 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9154 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9155 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9156 expansion item above.
9158 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9159 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9160 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9161 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9162 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9163 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9164 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9165 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9167 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9168 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9169 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9171 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9172 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9173 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9174 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9175 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9178 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9179 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9180 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9181 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9184 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9185 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9187 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9188 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9192 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9193 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9196 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9197 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9198 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9199 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9201 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9202 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9205 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9206 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9207 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9208 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9209 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9210 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9211 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9212 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9214 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9216 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9217 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9218 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9220 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9222 yields &"defabc"&, and
9224 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9226 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9227 the regular expression from string expansion.
9231 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9232 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9233 .cindex "substring extraction"
9234 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9235 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9236 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9237 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9238 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9240 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9242 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9243 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9246 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9247 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9248 length required. For example
9250 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9252 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9253 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9254 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9255 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9257 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9258 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9259 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9261 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9263 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9264 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9265 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9267 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9269 yields an empty string, but
9271 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9275 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9276 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9277 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9278 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9281 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9283 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9287 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9288 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9289 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9290 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9291 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9292 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9293 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9294 replacement list. For example
9296 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9298 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9299 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9300 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9306 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9307 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9308 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9309 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9310 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9311 following operations can be performed:
9314 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9315 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9316 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9317 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9318 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9319 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9322 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9323 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9324 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9325 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9326 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9327 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9328 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9329 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9330 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9332 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9333 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9334 character. For example:
9336 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9338 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9339 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9340 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9344 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9345 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9346 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9347 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9348 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9349 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9350 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9351 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9352 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9354 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9355 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9356 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9357 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9358 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9359 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9362 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9363 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9364 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9365 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9366 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9369 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9370 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9371 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9372 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9373 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9374 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9375 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9378 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9379 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9380 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9381 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9382 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9383 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9384 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9385 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9386 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9387 C programming language):
9389 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9390 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9391 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9392 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9395 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9397 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9398 space is permitted before or after operators.
9400 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9401 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9402 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9403 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9404 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9406 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9407 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9408 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9411 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9412 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9413 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9414 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9415 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9416 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9417 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9418 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9419 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9420 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9421 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9424 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9426 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9429 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9432 {$recipients_count} \
9433 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9437 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9438 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9441 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9442 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9443 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9446 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9448 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9449 and then re-expands what it has found.
9452 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9454 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9455 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9456 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9457 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9458 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9459 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9460 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9461 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9462 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9464 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9465 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9466 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9467 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9468 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9469 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9470 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9473 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9474 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9475 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9476 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9477 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9478 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9480 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9482 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9483 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9487 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9488 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9489 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9490 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9491 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9492 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9495 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9496 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9497 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9498 .cindex "lower casing"
9499 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9500 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9501 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9506 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9507 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9508 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9509 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9510 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9511 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9513 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9515 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9516 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9517 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9520 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9521 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9522 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9523 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9524 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9528 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9529 .cindex "masked IP address"
9530 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9531 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9532 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9533 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9534 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9535 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9536 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9537 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9538 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9540 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9542 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9543 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9544 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9545 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9547 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9551 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9553 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9556 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9558 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9559 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9560 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9561 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9564 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9565 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9566 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9567 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9568 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9569 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9571 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9573 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9576 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9577 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9578 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9579 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9580 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9581 is an empty string or
9582 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9583 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9584 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9585 respectively For example,
9593 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9594 variable or a message header.
9596 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9597 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9598 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9599 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9600 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9601 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9602 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9605 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9606 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9607 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9608 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9609 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9611 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9617 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9618 yields an unchanged string.
9621 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9622 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9623 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9624 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9625 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9626 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9627 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9628 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9629 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9632 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9634 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9635 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9639 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9640 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9641 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9642 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9643 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9644 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9645 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9646 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9648 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9649 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9650 to use this operator as well.
9654 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9655 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9656 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9657 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9658 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9659 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9660 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9663 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9664 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9665 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9666 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9667 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9668 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9671 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9672 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9673 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9674 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9675 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9676 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9677 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9678 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9679 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9680 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9681 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9682 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9683 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9685 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9686 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9687 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9689 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9690 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9691 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9692 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9693 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9697 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9698 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9699 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9700 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9701 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9702 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9705 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9706 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9707 .cindex "substring extraction"
9708 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9709 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9710 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9711 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9713 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9715 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9716 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9718 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9719 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9720 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9721 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9724 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9725 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9726 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9727 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9728 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9729 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9732 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9733 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9734 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9735 .cindex "upper casing"
9736 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9737 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9738 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9746 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9747 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9748 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9749 while expanding strings:
9752 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9753 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9754 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9755 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9758 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9759 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9760 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9761 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9767 &`>= `& greater or equal
9769 &`<= `& less or equal
9773 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9775 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9776 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9777 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9778 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9779 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9782 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9783 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9784 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9785 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9786 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9787 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9788 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9789 included in the binary.
9791 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9792 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9793 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9794 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9795 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9796 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9797 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9798 string in LDAP form is:
9800 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9802 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9803 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9805 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9807 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9812 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9813 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9814 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9815 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9816 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9817 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9821 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9822 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9823 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9824 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9825 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9826 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9829 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9830 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9831 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9832 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9833 whatever its length.
9836 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9837 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9838 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9839 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9841 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9842 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9843 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9844 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9845 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9846 support &[crypt16()]&.
9848 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9849 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9850 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9851 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9852 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9854 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9855 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9856 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9858 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9859 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9860 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9861 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9862 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9864 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9865 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9866 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9867 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9868 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9869 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9871 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9873 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9874 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9876 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9877 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9878 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9879 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9880 exists in the message. For example,
9882 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9884 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9885 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9887 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9888 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9889 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9891 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9892 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9893 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9894 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9895 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9897 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9898 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9899 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9900 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9901 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9902 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9903 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9904 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9906 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9907 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9908 .cindex "first delivery"
9909 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9910 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9911 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9912 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9915 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9916 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9917 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9918 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9919 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9921 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9922 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9923 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9924 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9925 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9927 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9928 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9929 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9931 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9932 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9933 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9935 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9936 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9937 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9938 list separator is changed to a comma:
9940 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9942 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9943 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9946 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9947 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9949 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9950 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9951 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9952 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9953 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9954 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9957 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9958 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9959 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9960 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9961 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9962 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9963 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9964 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9965 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9968 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9969 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9970 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9972 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9973 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9974 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9975 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9976 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9977 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9978 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9980 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9981 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9982 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9983 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
9984 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
9986 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
9987 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
9988 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
9989 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
9991 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9993 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9995 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
9996 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
9997 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
9998 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
9999 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10000 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10001 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10002 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10003 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10004 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10005 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10006 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10007 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10011 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10012 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10013 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10014 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10015 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10016 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10017 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10018 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10019 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10022 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10023 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10024 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10025 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10026 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10027 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10028 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10029 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10030 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10034 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10035 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10036 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10037 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10038 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10039 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10040 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10041 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10042 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10043 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10044 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10047 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10049 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10050 backslashes is also required.
10052 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10053 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10054 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10055 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10056 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10057 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10059 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10060 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10061 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10062 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10063 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10064 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10065 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10066 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10068 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10069 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10070 See &*match_local_part*&.
10072 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10073 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10074 See &*match_local_part*&.
10076 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10077 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10078 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10079 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10080 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10081 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10083 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10085 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10088 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10090 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10092 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10093 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10094 in a single test such as
10095 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10096 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10097 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10098 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10100 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10102 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10104 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10106 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10107 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10108 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10109 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10110 masks. For example:
10112 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10114 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10115 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10116 address mask, for example:
10118 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10120 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10121 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10123 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10127 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10129 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10130 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10131 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10132 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10133 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10134 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10135 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10136 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10139 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10141 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10142 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10143 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10144 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10146 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10148 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10149 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10150 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10151 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10154 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10155 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10156 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10157 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10159 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10160 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10161 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10162 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10163 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10164 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10165 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10166 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10167 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10168 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10169 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10173 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10174 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10176 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10177 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10178 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10179 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10180 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10181 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10182 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10184 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10185 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10186 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10187 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10188 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10190 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10192 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10194 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10196 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10197 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10198 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10199 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10200 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10201 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10202 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10203 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10206 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10207 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10209 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10210 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10211 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10212 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10213 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10214 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10216 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10217 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10218 building Exim. For example:
10220 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10222 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10223 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10224 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10225 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10227 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10228 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10229 configuration, you might have this:
10231 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10233 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10234 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10235 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10236 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10237 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10238 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10241 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10243 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10244 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10245 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10246 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10247 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10250 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10251 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10252 this library, you need to set
10254 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10256 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10257 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10259 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10261 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10262 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10263 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10265 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10266 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10267 the authentication is successful. For example:
10269 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10273 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10274 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10275 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10277 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10278 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10279 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10280 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10281 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10282 by a process that is not running as root.
10284 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10285 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10286 building Exim. For example:
10288 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10290 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10291 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10292 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10294 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10295 two are mandatory. For example:
10297 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10299 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10300 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10301 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10306 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10307 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10308 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10309 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10310 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10311 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10312 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10316 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10317 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10318 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10319 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10320 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10323 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10325 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10326 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10327 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10329 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10330 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10331 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10332 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10333 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10334 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10335 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10336 parsed but not evaluated.
10338 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10343 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10344 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10345 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10346 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10347 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10350 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10351 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10352 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10353 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10354 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10355 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10356 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10357 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10358 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10359 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10360 matching condition.
10362 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10363 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10364 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10365 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10366 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10367 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10368 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10369 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10370 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10371 during subsequent delivery.
10373 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10374 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10375 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10376 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10377 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10378 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10379 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10380 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10383 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10384 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10385 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10386 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10387 be preserved by coding like this:
10389 warn !verify = sender
10390 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10392 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10393 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10396 .vitem &$address_data$&
10397 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10398 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10399 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10400 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10401 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10402 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10405 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10406 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10407 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10408 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10409 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10410 from the child's routing.
10412 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10413 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10414 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10417 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10418 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10419 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10421 .vitem &$address_file$&
10422 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10423 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10424 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10425 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10426 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10428 /home/r2d2/savemail
10430 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10431 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10432 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10433 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10434 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10435 to the relevant file.
10437 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10438 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10439 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10440 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10442 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10443 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10444 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10445 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10447 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10448 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10449 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10450 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10451 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10452 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10453 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10454 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10455 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10456 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10457 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10458 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10459 command line option.
10464 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10465 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10466 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10467 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10468 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10469 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10470 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10471 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10472 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10473 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10474 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10476 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10477 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10478 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10479 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10480 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10483 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10484 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10485 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10486 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10487 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10488 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10489 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10490 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10491 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10492 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10493 an undefined mechanism.
10495 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10496 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10497 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10498 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10499 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10500 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10502 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10503 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10504 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10505 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10506 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10507 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10508 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10510 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10511 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10512 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10513 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10514 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10516 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10517 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10518 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10519 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10520 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10522 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10523 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10524 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10525 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10526 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10527 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10528 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10530 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10531 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10532 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10533 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10534 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10535 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10536 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10538 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10539 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10540 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10542 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10543 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10544 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10545 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10546 compilations of the same version of the program.
10548 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10549 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10550 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10551 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10552 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10554 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10555 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10556 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10557 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10558 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10560 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10561 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10562 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10564 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10565 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10566 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10567 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10568 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10569 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10570 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10571 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10572 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10575 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10576 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10577 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10578 case for &$domain$&.
10580 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10581 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10582 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10583 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10585 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10586 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10587 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10588 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10589 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10590 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10592 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10593 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10594 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10596 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10599 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10600 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10601 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10602 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10603 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10604 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10605 the &(smtp)& transport.
10608 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10609 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10610 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10611 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10614 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10615 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10616 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10617 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10618 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10619 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10622 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10623 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10624 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10625 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10629 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10630 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10631 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10632 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10633 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10634 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10635 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10638 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10639 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10640 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10643 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10644 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10645 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10647 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10648 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10649 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10651 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10652 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10653 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10655 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10656 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10657 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10658 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10659 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10661 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10662 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10663 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10664 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10665 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10669 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10670 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10671 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10672 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10673 by a setting on the transport itself.
10675 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10676 of the environment variable HOME.
10680 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10681 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10682 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10683 to local and remote transports.
10685 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10686 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10687 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10688 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10689 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10690 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10691 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10694 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10695 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10696 client is connected.
10699 .vitem &$host_address$&
10700 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10701 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10702 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10703 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10705 .vitem &$host_data$&
10706 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10707 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10708 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10709 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10711 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10712 message = $host_data
10714 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10715 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10716 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10717 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10718 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10719 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10720 variables is set to &"1"&.
10723 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10724 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10727 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10728 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10729 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10732 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10733 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10734 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10735 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10736 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10737 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10738 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10739 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10740 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10741 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10743 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10744 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10745 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10749 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10750 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10751 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10752 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10753 a unique name for the file.
10755 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10756 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10757 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10759 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10760 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10761 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10765 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10766 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*man*&, and
10767 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10771 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10772 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10773 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10776 .vitem &$load_average$&
10777 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10778 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10779 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10780 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10782 .vitem &$local_part$&
10783 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10784 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10785 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10786 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10787 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10789 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10790 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10791 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10792 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10795 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10796 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10797 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10798 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10799 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10800 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10802 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10803 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10804 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10807 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10808 local part of the recipient address.
10810 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10811 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10812 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10814 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10817 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10818 abc\:xyz@test.example
10820 the value of &$local_part$& is
10824 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10825 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10828 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10830 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10831 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10832 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10834 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10835 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10836 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10837 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10838 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10839 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10840 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10842 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10843 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10844 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10845 variable expands to nothing.
10847 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10848 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10849 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10850 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10851 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10853 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10854 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10855 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10856 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10857 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10859 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10860 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10861 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10862 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10864 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10865 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10866 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10868 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10869 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10870 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10871 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10872 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10873 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10874 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10875 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10877 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10878 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10879 This contains the expanded value of the
10880 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10883 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10884 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10885 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10886 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10887 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10888 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10890 .vitem &$log_space$&
10891 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10892 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10893 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10894 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10895 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10896 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10899 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10900 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10901 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10902 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10903 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10904 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10905 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10908 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10909 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10910 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10911 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10912 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10914 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10915 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10916 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10917 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10918 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10919 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10922 .vitem &$message_age$&
10923 .cindex "message" "age of"
10924 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10925 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10926 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10929 .vitem &$message_body$&
10930 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10931 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10932 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10933 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10934 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10935 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10936 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10937 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10938 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10940 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10941 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10942 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10943 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10944 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10946 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10947 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10948 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10949 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10950 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10951 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10954 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10955 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10956 .cindex "message body" "size"
10957 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10958 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10959 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10960 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10961 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10963 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10964 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10965 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10966 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10967 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10968 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10969 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10970 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10972 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10973 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10974 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10975 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10976 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
10977 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
10979 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
10980 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
10981 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
10982 contents of header lines is done.
10984 .vitem &$message_id$&
10985 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
10987 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
10988 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
10989 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
10990 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
10991 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
10992 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
10993 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
10994 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
10995 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
10996 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
10999 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11001 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11003 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11004 message has not yet been received.
11006 .vitem &$message_size$&
11007 .cindex "size" "of message"
11008 .cindex "message" "size"
11009 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11010 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11011 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11012 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11013 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11014 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11015 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11016 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11017 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11019 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11020 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
11021 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11022 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11024 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11025 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11026 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11027 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11029 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11030 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11031 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11033 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11034 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11035 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11036 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11037 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11038 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11039 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11040 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11041 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11042 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11044 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11045 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11046 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11048 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11049 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11050 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11051 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11052 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11053 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11054 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11055 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11056 the original address.
11058 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11059 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11060 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11061 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11062 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11064 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11065 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11066 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11068 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11069 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11070 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11071 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11072 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11073 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11074 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11075 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11076 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11078 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11079 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11080 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11081 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11082 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11083 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11084 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11085 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11088 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11089 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11090 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11091 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11093 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11094 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11095 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11096 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11099 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11101 This variable contains the current process id.
11103 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11104 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11105 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11106 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11107 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11108 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11109 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11110 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11111 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11112 variable"& error if encountered.
11114 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11115 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11116 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11117 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11118 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11119 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11120 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11123 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11124 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11125 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11126 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11128 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11129 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11130 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11131 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11133 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11134 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11135 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11136 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11138 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11139 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11140 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11142 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11143 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11144 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11145 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11147 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11148 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11149 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11150 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11151 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11153 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11154 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11155 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11156 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11157 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11158 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11160 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11161 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11162 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11163 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11164 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11166 .vitem &$received_count$&
11167 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11168 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11169 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11170 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11173 .vitem &$received_for$&
11174 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11175 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11176 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11177 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11178 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11180 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11181 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11182 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11183 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11184 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11185 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11186 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11189 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11190 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11191 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11192 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11193 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11196 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11197 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11198 &(smtp)& transport).
11200 .vitem &$received_port$&
11201 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11202 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11204 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11205 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11206 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11207 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11208 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11209 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11210 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11211 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11212 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11214 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11215 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11216 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11217 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11218 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11219 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11221 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11222 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11223 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11225 .vitem &$received_time$&
11226 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11227 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11228 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11230 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11231 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11232 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11233 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11234 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11236 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11237 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11239 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11240 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11241 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11242 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11244 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11245 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11246 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11247 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11250 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11251 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11254 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11257 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11258 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11262 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11265 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11268 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11269 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11271 .vitem &$recipients$&
11272 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11273 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11274 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11275 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11276 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11280 In a system filter file.
11282 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11283 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11284 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11285 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11287 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11291 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11292 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11293 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11294 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11295 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11296 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11299 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11300 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11301 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11302 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11305 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11306 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11307 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11308 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11309 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11310 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11311 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11313 .vitem &$return_path$&
11314 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11315 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11316 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11317 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11318 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11319 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11320 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11321 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11322 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11323 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11326 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11327 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11328 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11331 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11332 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11333 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11334 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11335 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11336 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11337 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11340 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11341 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11342 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11343 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11344 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11345 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11346 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11347 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11349 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11350 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11351 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11352 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11353 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11354 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11356 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11357 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11358 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11359 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11360 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11361 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11362 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11363 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11365 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11366 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11367 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11369 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11370 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11371 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11373 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11374 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11375 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11376 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11377 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11380 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11381 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11383 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11384 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11385 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11386 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11388 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11389 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11390 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11391 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11392 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11393 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11394 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11395 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11396 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11397 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11398 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11399 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11400 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11402 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11403 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11404 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11405 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11406 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11407 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11409 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11410 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11411 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11412 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11414 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11415 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11416 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11417 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11418 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11419 &$authenticated_id$&.
11421 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11422 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11423 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11424 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11425 other means, this variable is empty.
11427 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11428 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11429 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11430 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11431 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11432 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11433 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11435 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11436 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11437 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11438 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11440 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11441 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11442 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11445 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11446 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11447 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11448 following are true:
11451 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11453 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11454 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11455 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11457 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11458 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11459 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11461 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11462 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11463 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11465 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11466 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11467 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11468 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11470 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11472 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11473 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11477 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11478 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11479 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11480 number that was used on the remote host.
11482 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11483 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11484 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11485 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11486 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11489 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11490 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11491 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11492 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11494 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11495 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11496 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11497 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11498 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11499 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11500 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11501 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11502 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11503 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11504 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11507 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11508 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11509 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11510 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11511 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11513 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11514 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11515 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11516 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11517 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11519 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11520 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11521 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11522 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11523 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11524 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11525 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11527 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11528 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11529 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11530 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11531 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11533 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11534 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11535 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11536 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11537 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11538 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11540 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11541 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11542 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11543 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11544 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11549 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11550 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11551 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11552 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11554 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11555 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11556 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11557 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11558 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11559 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11560 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11562 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11563 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11564 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11565 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11566 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11567 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11568 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11569 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11570 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11571 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11572 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11574 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11575 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11576 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11577 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11578 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11579 message is junk mail.
11581 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11582 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11583 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11584 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11587 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11588 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11589 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11591 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11592 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11593 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11594 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11595 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11596 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11598 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11599 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11600 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11601 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11602 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11603 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11604 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11605 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11607 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11609 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11612 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11613 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11614 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11615 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11616 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11617 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11619 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11620 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11621 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11622 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11624 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11625 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11626 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11627 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11628 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11629 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11630 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11631 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11633 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11634 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11635 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11636 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11637 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11638 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11640 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11641 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11642 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11643 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11644 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11645 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11646 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11649 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11650 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11651 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11652 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11654 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11655 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11656 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11658 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11659 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11660 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11661 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11662 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11663 values for those that are behind (west).
11666 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11667 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11668 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11670 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11671 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11672 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11673 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11676 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11677 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11678 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11681 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11682 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11683 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11684 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11687 .vindex "&$value$&"
11688 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11689 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11690 &*reduce*& expansion.
11692 .vitem &$version_number$&
11693 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11694 The version number of Exim.
11696 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11697 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11698 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11699 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11701 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11702 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11703 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11704 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11713 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11714 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11715 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11716 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11717 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11718 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11723 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11726 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11727 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11728 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11729 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11730 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11731 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11732 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11733 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11734 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11736 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11737 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11738 should usually be something like
11740 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11742 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11743 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11744 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11745 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11746 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11747 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11748 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11749 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11753 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11754 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11755 a startup when Exim is entered.
11757 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11758 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11761 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11762 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11765 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11766 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11767 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11768 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11772 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11773 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11775 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11776 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11777 with an error message of the form
11779 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11781 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11782 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11783 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11784 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11785 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11786 that was passed to &%die%&.
11789 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11790 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11791 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11794 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11796 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11797 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11798 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11800 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11801 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11802 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11803 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11805 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11806 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11807 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11808 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11809 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11810 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11811 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11814 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11815 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11816 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11817 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11818 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11819 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11820 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11821 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11822 avoided, but the output is lost.
11824 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11825 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11826 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11827 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11828 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11829 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11830 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11832 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11834 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11835 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11836 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11837 as the first subroutine argument.
11841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11844 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11845 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11846 "Starting the daemon"
11847 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11848 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11849 .cindex "network interface"
11850 .cindex "interface" "network"
11851 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11852 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11853 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11854 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11855 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11856 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11857 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11858 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11859 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11860 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11861 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11864 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11865 and ports to listen on.
11867 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11868 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11869 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11870 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11871 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11872 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11873 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11874 as an error situation.
11876 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11877 for the outgoing connection.
11881 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11882 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11883 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11884 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11885 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11887 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11888 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11889 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11890 chapter describes how they operate.
11892 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11893 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11897 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11898 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11899 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11903 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11904 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11906 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11907 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11910 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11911 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11912 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11913 colons. For example:
11915 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11918 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11920 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11921 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11924 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11925 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11927 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11928 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11931 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11932 with a colon separator, for example:
11934 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11935 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11939 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11940 default setting contains just one port:
11942 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11944 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11945 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11946 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11947 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11948 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11952 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11953 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11954 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11955 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11956 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11957 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11959 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11961 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11963 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11965 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11969 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11970 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11971 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11972 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11973 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11974 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
11977 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
11978 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
11979 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
11980 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
11981 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11982 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
11986 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
11989 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
11991 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
11992 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
11993 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
11997 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
11998 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
11999 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12000 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12001 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12002 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12003 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12004 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12005 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12006 common use of this option is expected to be
12008 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12010 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12011 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12012 this way when a daemon is started.
12014 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12015 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12016 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12017 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12018 connections via the daemon.)
12023 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12024 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12025 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12026 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12027 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12028 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12029 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12030 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12032 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12034 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12035 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12036 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12037 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12038 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12039 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12041 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12043 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12044 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12045 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12046 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12047 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12049 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12050 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12051 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12052 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12053 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12054 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12055 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12056 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12057 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12058 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12059 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12060 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12062 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12063 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12064 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12065 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12066 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12070 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12071 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12073 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12074 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12076 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12077 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12078 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12079 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12081 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12083 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12085 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12087 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12088 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12090 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12091 IPv4 loopback address only:
12093 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12095 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12097 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12099 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12103 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12104 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12105 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12106 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12109 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12110 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12111 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12112 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12114 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12115 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12116 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12117 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12118 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12119 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12120 used for listening. Consider this example:
12122 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12124 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12126 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12128 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12129 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12132 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12133 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12134 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12135 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12136 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12137 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12138 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12139 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12143 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12144 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12145 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12146 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12147 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12148 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12157 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12158 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12159 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12160 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12163 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12164 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12166 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12167 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12168 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12170 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12171 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12172 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12173 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12177 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12178 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12179 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12180 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12181 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12182 listed in more than one group.
12184 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12186 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12187 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12188 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12189 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12190 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12191 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12192 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12193 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12194 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12198 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12200 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12201 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12202 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12203 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12204 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12205 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12210 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12212 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12213 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12214 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12215 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12216 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12217 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12218 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12219 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12220 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12221 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12222 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12227 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12229 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12230 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12231 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12232 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12233 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12234 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12235 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12236 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12237 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12238 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12239 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12240 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12245 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12247 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12248 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12249 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12250 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12255 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12257 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12258 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12259 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12260 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12261 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12262 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12263 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12264 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12269 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12271 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12272 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12277 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12279 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12280 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12285 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12287 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12288 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12289 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12290 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12291 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12292 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12293 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12298 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12300 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12301 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12302 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12303 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12304 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12305 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12306 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12307 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12308 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12309 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12310 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12311 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12312 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12313 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12314 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12315 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12317 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12318 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12319 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12320 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12321 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12326 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12328 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12329 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12330 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12331 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12332 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12333 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12334 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12335 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12336 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12337 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12338 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12339 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12340 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12341 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12342 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12343 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12344 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12345 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12346 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12348 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12349 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12350 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12351 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12352 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12353 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12354 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12355 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12356 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12357 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12358 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12359 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12360 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12361 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12362 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12363 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12364 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12365 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12370 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12372 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12374 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12376 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12377 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12378 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12383 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12385 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12386 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12387 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12388 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12389 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12390 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12391 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12392 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12393 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12394 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12395 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12396 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12397 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12398 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12403 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12405 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12406 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12407 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12408 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12409 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12410 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12411 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12412 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12417 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12419 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12420 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12421 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12422 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12423 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12424 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12425 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12426 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12432 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12434 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12441 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12442 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12445 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12446 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12447 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12448 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12449 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12450 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12451 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12452 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12453 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12454 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12455 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12456 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12457 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12458 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12460 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12461 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12462 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12463 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12464 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12465 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12466 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12467 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12468 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12469 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12470 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12471 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12472 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12473 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12474 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12475 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12480 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12482 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12483 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12484 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12485 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12486 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12487 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12492 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12494 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12495 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12496 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12497 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12499 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12500 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12501 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12502 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12503 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12504 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12505 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12506 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12507 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12508 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12513 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12515 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12516 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12518 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12519 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12520 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12521 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12522 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12527 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12529 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12530 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12531 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12532 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12533 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12534 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12535 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12536 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12537 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12538 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12539 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12540 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12541 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12542 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12543 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12544 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12545 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12546 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12547 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12548 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12549 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12554 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12556 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12557 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12558 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12559 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12560 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12561 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12562 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12563 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12564 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12565 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12566 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12567 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12568 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12569 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12574 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12575 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12578 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12580 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12581 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12582 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12583 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12584 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12585 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12587 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12588 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12589 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12590 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12591 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12594 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12595 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12596 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12599 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12600 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12601 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12602 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12603 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12605 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12606 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12607 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12608 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12609 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12611 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12612 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12613 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12614 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12616 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12617 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12618 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12619 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12620 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12622 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12623 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12624 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12625 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12627 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12628 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12629 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12630 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12632 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12633 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12634 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12635 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12636 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12639 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12640 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12641 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12642 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12644 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12645 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12646 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12647 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12648 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12650 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12651 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12652 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12653 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12654 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12656 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12657 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12658 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12661 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12662 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12663 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12664 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12666 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12667 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12668 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12669 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12671 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12672 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12673 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12674 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12676 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12677 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12678 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12679 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12681 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12682 .cindex "admin user"
12683 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12684 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12685 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12686 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12687 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12688 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12689 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12691 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12692 .cindex "domain literal"
12693 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12694 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12695 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12696 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12698 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12699 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12700 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12701 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12702 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12703 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12704 the local host's IP addresses.
12707 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12708 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12709 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12710 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12711 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12712 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12713 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12714 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12715 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12717 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12718 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12719 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12720 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12721 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12722 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12723 experiment if they wish.
12725 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12726 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12727 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12728 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12729 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12730 suitable setting is:
12732 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12733 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12735 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12737 dns_check_names_pattern =
12739 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12742 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12743 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12744 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12745 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12746 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12747 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12748 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12749 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12750 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12751 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12752 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12754 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12755 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12756 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12757 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12758 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12759 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12761 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12762 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12763 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12764 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12766 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12768 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12769 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12770 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12771 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12774 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12775 .cindex "thawing messages"
12776 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12777 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12778 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12779 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12780 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12781 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12783 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12784 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12785 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12787 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12788 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12789 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12791 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12793 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12794 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12798 .option bi_command main string unset
12800 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12801 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12802 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12803 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12806 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12807 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12808 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12809 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12810 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12811 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12814 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12815 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12816 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12817 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12819 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12820 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12821 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12822 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12823 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12824 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12825 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12826 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12827 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12828 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12830 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12831 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12832 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12833 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12836 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12837 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12838 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12839 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12840 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12841 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12842 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12843 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12844 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12846 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12847 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12848 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12849 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12850 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12853 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12854 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12855 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12856 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12857 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12858 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12859 connection. A typical setting might be:
12861 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12863 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12865 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12867 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12870 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12871 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12872 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12873 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12874 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12875 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12878 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12879 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12880 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12881 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12884 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12885 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12886 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12887 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12890 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12891 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12892 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12893 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12896 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12897 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12898 callout verification. The default value is
12900 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12902 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12905 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12906 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12909 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12910 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12912 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12913 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12914 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12915 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12916 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12917 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12918 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12919 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12920 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12921 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12924 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12925 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12928 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12929 .cindex "checking disk space"
12930 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12931 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12932 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12933 message is accepted.
12935 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12936 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12937 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12938 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12939 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12940 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12941 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12942 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12945 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12946 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12948 check_spool_space = 10M
12949 check_spool_inodes = 100
12951 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12952 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12955 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12956 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12957 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12959 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12960 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12961 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12962 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12963 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12964 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12966 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12967 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12969 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12970 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12971 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12973 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12974 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
12975 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12976 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
12977 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
12978 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
12980 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
12981 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
12982 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
12983 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
12984 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
12985 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
12986 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
12988 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
12989 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
12991 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
12992 .cindex "warning of delay"
12993 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
12994 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
12995 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
12996 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
12997 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
12998 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
12999 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13002 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13004 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13005 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13006 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13007 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13011 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13012 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13014 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13017 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13018 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13019 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13020 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13021 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13022 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13023 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13024 not sent. The default is:
13026 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13027 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13028 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13029 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13032 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13033 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13034 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13035 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13037 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13038 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13039 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13040 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13041 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13042 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13043 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13044 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13046 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13047 .cindex "load average"
13048 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13049 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13050 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13051 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13052 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13055 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13056 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13057 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13058 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13059 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13060 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13061 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13062 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13064 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13065 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13066 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13067 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13068 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13069 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13070 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13071 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13073 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13074 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13075 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13076 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13079 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13080 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13081 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13082 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13083 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13084 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13085 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13088 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13089 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13090 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13091 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13092 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13093 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13094 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13095 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13096 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13097 by a setting such as this:
13099 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13101 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13102 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13103 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13104 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13105 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13106 options are applied after this global option.
13108 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13109 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13110 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13111 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13112 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13113 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13114 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13115 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13116 value of this option. The default pattern is
13118 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13119 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13121 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13122 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13123 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13124 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13125 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13128 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13129 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13130 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13132 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13133 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13134 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13135 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13137 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13138 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13139 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13140 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13141 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13142 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13143 domain matches this list.
13145 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13146 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13147 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13150 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13151 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13152 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13153 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13154 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13155 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13156 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13157 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13158 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13159 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13163 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13164 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13167 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13168 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13169 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13170 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13172 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13173 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13174 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13175 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13176 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13177 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13179 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13181 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13182 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13184 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13185 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13186 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13187 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13188 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13189 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13190 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13191 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13192 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13195 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13196 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13197 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13198 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13199 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13200 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13201 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13202 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13203 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13205 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13206 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13207 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13208 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13209 are examined. For example:
13211 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13212 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13213 postmaster@mydomain.example
13215 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13216 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13217 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13218 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13219 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13220 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13221 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13224 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13225 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13226 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13228 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13230 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13231 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13232 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13233 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13234 overrides the default.
13236 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13237 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13238 and warning messages. For example:
13240 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13242 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13243 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13244 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13245 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13249 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13250 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13251 .cindex "Exim group"
13252 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13253 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13254 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13255 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13256 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13260 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13261 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13262 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13263 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13264 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13265 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13267 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13268 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13269 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13270 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13273 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13274 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13275 .cindex "Exim user"
13276 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13277 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13278 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13279 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13281 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13282 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13283 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13284 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13287 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13288 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13289 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13290 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13293 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13294 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13296 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13297 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13299 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13300 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13301 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13302 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13303 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13304 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13305 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13306 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13307 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13308 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13312 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13313 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13314 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13315 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13316 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13317 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13318 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13319 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13322 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13323 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13324 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13325 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13329 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13330 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13331 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13332 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13333 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13334 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13335 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13336 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13337 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13338 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13339 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13340 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13341 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13342 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13343 logging that you require.
13346 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13348 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13349 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13350 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13351 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13352 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13353 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13354 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13355 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13357 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13358 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13359 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13362 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13363 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13364 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13365 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13367 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13371 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13372 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13375 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13376 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13377 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13379 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13380 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13381 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13383 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13384 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13385 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13388 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13389 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13390 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13391 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13392 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13393 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13397 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13398 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13399 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13400 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13401 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13402 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13403 sections are rejected.
13406 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13407 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13408 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13409 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13410 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13411 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13412 zero means &"no limit"&.
13417 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13418 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13419 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13420 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13421 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13422 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13423 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13424 if you want to do semantic checking.
13425 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13429 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13430 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13431 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13432 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13433 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13434 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13435 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13437 helo_allow_chars = _
13439 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13442 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13443 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13444 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13445 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13446 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13447 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13448 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13452 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13453 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13454 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13455 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13456 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13457 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13458 condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13459 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13460 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13461 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
13462 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13463 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13465 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13466 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13467 EHLO command either:
13470 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13472 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13473 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13474 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13475 calling host address, or
13477 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13478 available) yields the calling host address.
13481 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13482 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13483 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
13485 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13486 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13487 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13488 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13489 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13490 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13491 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13492 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13493 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13496 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13497 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13498 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13499 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13500 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13501 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13502 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13503 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13504 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13506 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13507 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13508 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13509 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13510 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13512 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13513 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13514 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13515 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13518 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13519 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13520 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13521 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13522 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13523 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13524 default configuration file contains
13528 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13529 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13531 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13532 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13533 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13535 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13536 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13537 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13538 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13539 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
13540 &`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13543 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13544 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13545 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13546 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13547 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13550 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13551 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13552 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13553 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13557 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13558 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13559 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13560 as soon as the connection is made.
13561 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13562 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13563 connections immediately.
13565 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13566 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13567 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13568 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13569 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13572 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13573 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13574 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13575 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13576 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13577 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13578 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13579 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13580 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13582 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13584 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13588 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13589 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13590 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13591 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13592 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13594 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13595 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13597 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13598 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13599 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13600 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13601 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13602 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13603 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13606 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13607 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13608 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13609 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13610 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13614 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13615 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13616 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13617 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13618 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13619 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13621 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13622 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13623 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13624 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13625 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13626 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13627 for frozen messages. For example,
13629 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13631 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13632 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13633 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13634 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13635 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13636 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13639 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13640 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13641 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13642 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13643 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13644 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13645 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13646 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13647 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13648 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13651 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13652 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13655 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13656 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13657 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13658 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13662 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13663 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13664 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13665 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13666 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13670 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13671 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13672 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13673 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13674 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13675 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13676 has been built with LDAP support.
13680 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13681 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13682 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13683 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13684 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13685 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13686 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13688 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13689 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13690 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13692 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13693 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13694 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13695 and the default qualify domain.
13697 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13698 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13699 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13700 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13702 .cindex "envelope sender"
13703 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13704 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13705 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13707 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13708 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13709 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13714 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13715 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13716 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13717 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13718 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13719 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13720 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13723 local_from_prefix = *-
13725 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13727 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13729 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13730 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13734 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13735 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13738 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13739 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13740 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13742 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13743 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13744 &%local_interfaces%& is
13746 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13748 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13750 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13753 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13754 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13755 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13756 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13757 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13758 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13759 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13760 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13764 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13765 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13766 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13767 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13768 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13769 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13770 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13771 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13776 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13777 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13778 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13779 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13780 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13781 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13782 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13783 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13784 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13785 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13786 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13787 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13788 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13789 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13790 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13794 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13795 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13796 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13797 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13798 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13799 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13800 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13801 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13802 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13803 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13804 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13805 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13806 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13807 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13810 .option log_selector main string unset
13811 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13812 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13813 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13814 minus characters. For example:
13816 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13818 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13819 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13822 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13823 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13824 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13825 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13826 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13827 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13828 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13829 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13830 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13831 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13832 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13833 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13834 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13837 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13838 .cindex "too many open files"
13839 .cindex "open files, too many"
13840 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13841 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13842 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13843 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13844 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13845 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13846 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13847 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13848 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13849 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13850 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13851 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13854 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13855 .cindex "length of login name"
13856 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13857 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13858 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13859 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13860 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13861 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13864 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13865 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13866 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13867 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13868 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13869 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13870 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13871 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13874 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13875 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13876 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13877 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13878 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13879 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13880 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13883 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13884 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13885 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13886 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13887 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13888 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13889 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13890 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13891 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13892 empty string, the option is ignored.
13895 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13896 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13897 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13898 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13899 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13900 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13901 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13902 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13903 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13904 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13905 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13906 colons will become hyphens.
13909 .option message_logs main boolean true
13910 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13911 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13912 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13913 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13914 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13915 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13916 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13917 which is not affected by this option.
13920 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13921 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13922 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13923 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13924 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13925 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13926 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13927 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13928 optionally followed by K or M.
13930 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13931 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13932 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13933 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13934 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13936 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13937 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13938 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13939 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13940 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13941 message that an individual transport can process.
13944 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13945 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13946 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13948 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13950 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13951 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13952 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13953 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13954 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13957 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13958 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13959 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13960 contains a full description of this facility.
13964 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13965 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13966 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13967 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13968 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13971 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
13972 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
13973 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13974 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13975 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13978 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13979 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13980 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13981 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
13982 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13984 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
13985 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
13988 never_users = root:daemon:bin
13990 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
13991 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
13995 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
13996 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
13997 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
13998 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13999 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14002 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14003 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14004 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14005 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14006 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14007 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14008 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14009 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14010 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14011 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14014 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14015 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14016 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14017 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14018 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14019 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14020 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14023 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14024 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14025 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14028 .option perl_startup main string unset
14029 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14030 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14033 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14034 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14035 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14036 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14037 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14038 PostgreSQL support.
14041 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14042 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14043 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14044 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14045 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14048 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14050 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14052 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14053 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14054 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14057 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14058 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14059 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14060 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14061 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14062 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14063 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14064 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14065 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14068 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14069 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14070 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14071 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14072 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14073 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14074 volume of mail. Use with care!
14077 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14078 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14079 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14080 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14081 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14082 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14083 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14084 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14085 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14086 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14088 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14089 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14090 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14091 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14092 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14093 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14096 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14097 .cindex "printing characters"
14098 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14099 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14100 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14101 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14102 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14103 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14106 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14107 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14108 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14109 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14110 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14114 .option process_log_path main string unset
14115 .cindex "process log path"
14116 .cindex "log" "process log"
14117 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14118 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14119 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14120 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14121 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14122 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14123 different spool directories.
14126 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14130 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14131 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14132 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14135 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14136 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14137 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14138 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14139 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14140 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14141 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14142 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14143 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14145 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14146 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14147 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14148 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14149 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14150 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14151 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14154 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14155 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14156 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14160 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14161 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14162 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14163 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14164 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14165 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14166 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14167 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14170 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14172 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14173 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14174 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14177 .option queue_only main boolean false
14178 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14179 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14180 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14181 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14182 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14183 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14185 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14186 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14187 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14188 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14191 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14192 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14193 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14194 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14195 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14196 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14197 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14198 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14199 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14201 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14203 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14204 &_/some/file_& exists.
14207 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14208 .cindex "load average"
14209 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14210 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14211 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14212 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14213 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14214 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14215 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14218 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14219 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14220 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14221 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14224 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14225 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14226 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14227 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14228 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14229 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14230 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14231 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14232 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14233 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14234 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14235 re-evaluated for each message.
14238 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14239 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14240 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14241 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14242 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14243 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14246 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14247 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14248 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14249 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14250 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14251 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14252 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14253 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14254 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14255 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14256 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14257 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14258 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14262 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14263 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14264 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14265 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14266 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14267 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14268 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14269 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14270 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14272 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14273 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14274 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14275 the daemon's command line.
14277 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14278 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14279 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14280 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14281 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14282 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14283 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14284 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14285 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14286 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14287 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14288 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14289 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14293 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14294 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14295 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14296 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14297 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14298 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14299 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14301 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14302 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14303 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14304 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14305 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14306 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14307 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14308 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14309 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14310 header lines. The default setting is:
14313 received_header_text = Received: \
14314 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14315 {${if def:sender_ident \
14316 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14317 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14318 by $primary_hostname \
14319 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14320 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14321 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14322 ${if def:sender_address \
14323 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14324 id $message_exim_id\
14325 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14328 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14329 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14330 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14331 header lines such as the following:
14333 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14334 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14335 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14336 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14337 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14338 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14339 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14341 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14342 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14343 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14344 message was accepted.
14347 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14348 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14349 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14350 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14351 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14352 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14353 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14354 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14357 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14358 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14359 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14360 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14361 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14362 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14363 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14364 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14365 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14366 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14367 option was not set.
14370 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14371 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14372 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14373 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14374 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14375 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14376 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14377 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14380 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14381 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14382 RCPT commands in a single message.
14385 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14386 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14387 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14388 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14389 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14390 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14391 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14394 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14395 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14396 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14397 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14398 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14399 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14400 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14401 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14402 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14403 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14404 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14405 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14406 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14407 tagged with its process id.
14409 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14410 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14411 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14412 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14415 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14416 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14417 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14418 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14419 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14420 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14421 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14422 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14423 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14424 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14425 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14427 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14428 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14429 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14430 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14433 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14434 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14435 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14436 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14437 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14439 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14441 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14442 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14445 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14446 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14447 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14448 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14449 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14453 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14454 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14455 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14456 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14457 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14458 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14459 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14463 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14464 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14465 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14466 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14467 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14468 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14469 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14470 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14471 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14472 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14475 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14476 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14479 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14481 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14482 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14485 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14486 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14487 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14488 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14489 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14492 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14493 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14494 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14495 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14496 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14497 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14498 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14499 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14500 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14501 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14504 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14505 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14506 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14507 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14508 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14509 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14510 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14511 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14512 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14513 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14514 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14518 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14519 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14520 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14522 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14523 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14524 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14525 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14526 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14527 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14529 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14530 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14531 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14532 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14535 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14536 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14537 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14538 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14539 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14540 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14541 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14542 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14544 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14545 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14546 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14547 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14548 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14549 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14550 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14551 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14554 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14555 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14556 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14557 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14561 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14562 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14564 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14565 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14566 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14567 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14568 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14569 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14570 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14571 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14572 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14576 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14577 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14578 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14579 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14580 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14581 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14582 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14583 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14584 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14585 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14586 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14588 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14589 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14590 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14591 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14592 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14593 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14597 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14598 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14599 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14600 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14601 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14602 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14603 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14604 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14605 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14606 to all messages received in the same connection.
14608 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14609 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14610 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14611 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14614 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14615 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14617 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14618 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14619 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14620 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14621 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14622 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14623 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14624 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14625 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14626 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14627 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14628 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14629 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14632 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14633 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14634 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14635 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14636 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14637 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14638 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14639 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14640 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14641 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14642 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14645 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14646 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14647 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14648 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14651 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14652 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14653 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14654 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14655 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14656 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14657 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14658 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14659 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14661 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14662 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14663 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14664 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14666 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14667 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14668 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14669 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14670 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14673 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14674 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14677 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14678 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14679 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14680 &%helo_data%& value.
14682 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14683 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14684 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14685 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14686 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14687 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14688 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14690 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14691 $version_number $tod_full
14693 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14694 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14695 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14696 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14697 multiline response).
14700 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14701 .cindex "checking disk space"
14702 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14703 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14704 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14705 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14706 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14707 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14708 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14711 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14712 .cindex "connection backlog"
14713 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14714 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14715 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14716 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14717 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14718 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14719 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14720 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14721 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14722 attacks by SYN flooding.
14725 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14726 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14727 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14728 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14729 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14730 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14731 fewer, but they still exist.
14733 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14734 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14735 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14736 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14737 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14738 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14739 does detect many instances.
14741 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14742 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14743 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14744 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14748 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14749 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14750 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14751 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14752 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14753 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14754 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14755 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14758 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14759 $sender_host_address
14761 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14762 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14763 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14764 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14765 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14769 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14770 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14771 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14772 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14773 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14776 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14777 .cindex "load average"
14778 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14779 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14780 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14781 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14782 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14783 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14787 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14788 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14789 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14790 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14791 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14793 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14795 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14796 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14797 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14798 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14799 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14801 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14802 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14803 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14804 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14805 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14806 not count towards the limit.
14810 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14811 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14812 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14813 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14814 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14817 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14818 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14822 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14823 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14824 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14825 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14826 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14827 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14830 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14831 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14832 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14833 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14835 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14836 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14837 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14838 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14842 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14844 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14845 fractional parts are allowed here.
14847 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14849 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14850 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14853 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14854 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14856 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14857 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14859 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14860 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14861 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14862 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14865 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14866 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14869 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14870 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14873 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14874 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14875 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14876 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14877 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14878 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14879 the message is abandoned.
14880 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14882 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14883 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14885 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14886 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14890 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14891 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14892 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14893 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14894 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14897 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14898 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14899 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14902 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14903 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14904 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14905 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14906 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14907 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14908 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14909 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14910 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14911 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14913 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14914 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14917 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14918 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14919 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14920 The default value is
14924 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14928 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14929 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14930 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14931 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14932 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14933 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14934 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14935 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14936 arrival of the message.
14938 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14939 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14940 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14941 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14942 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14944 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14945 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14946 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14947 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14948 automatically deleted.
14950 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14951 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14952 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14953 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14954 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14955 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14956 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14957 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14958 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14961 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14962 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14963 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14964 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14965 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14966 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14967 &$primary_hostname$&.
14969 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14970 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14971 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
14972 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14973 as failures in the configuration file.
14975 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14976 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14978 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
14979 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
14980 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
14981 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
14983 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
14984 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
14985 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
14986 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
14987 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
14988 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
14990 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
14991 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
14992 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
14993 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
14994 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
14995 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
14996 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
14999 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15000 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15001 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15002 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15003 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15004 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15005 domain causes a syntax error.
15006 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15010 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15011 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15012 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15013 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15014 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15015 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15016 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15017 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15018 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15019 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15020 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15021 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15024 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15025 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15026 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15027 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15028 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15029 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15030 details of Exim's logging.
15034 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15035 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15036 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15037 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15038 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15042 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15043 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15044 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15045 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15046 details of Exim's logging.
15049 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15050 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15051 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15052 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15053 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15054 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15055 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15056 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15057 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15058 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15059 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15062 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15063 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15064 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15065 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15066 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15067 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15070 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15071 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15072 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15073 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15074 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15076 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15077 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15078 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15079 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15080 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15082 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15083 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15084 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15085 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15086 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15087 contains the pipe command.
15090 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15091 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15092 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15093 is used in a system filter.
15095 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15096 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15097 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15098 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15099 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15100 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15101 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15102 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15103 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15105 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15106 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15107 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15108 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15111 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15112 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15113 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15114 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15115 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15116 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15117 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15118 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15119 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15120 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15121 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15122 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15126 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15127 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15128 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15129 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15130 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15131 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15132 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15133 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15134 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15135 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15137 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15138 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15139 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15142 .option timezone main string unset
15143 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15144 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15145 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15146 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15147 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15151 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15152 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15153 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15154 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15155 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15156 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15159 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15160 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15161 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15162 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15163 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15164 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15165 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15166 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15169 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15170 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15171 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15172 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15173 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15174 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15175 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15177 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15178 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15179 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15180 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15183 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15184 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15185 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15186 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15187 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15190 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15191 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15192 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15193 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15194 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15195 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15198 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15199 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15200 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15201 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15202 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15206 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15207 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15208 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15209 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15210 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15211 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15212 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15215 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15216 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15217 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15218 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15219 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15220 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15224 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15225 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15226 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15227 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15228 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15229 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15230 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15231 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15232 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15233 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15234 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15237 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15238 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15239 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15240 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15243 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15244 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15245 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15246 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15247 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15248 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15249 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15250 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15251 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15254 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15255 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15256 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15257 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15258 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15259 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15260 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15261 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15263 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15264 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15265 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15266 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15267 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15268 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15269 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15271 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15272 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15273 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15274 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15275 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15276 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15277 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15280 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15284 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15285 .cindex "trusted groups"
15286 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15287 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15288 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15289 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15290 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15291 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15292 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15295 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15296 .cindex "trusted users"
15297 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15298 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15299 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15300 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15301 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15302 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15303 Exim user are trusted.
15305 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15306 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15307 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15308 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15309 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15310 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15311 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15312 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15313 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15316 .option unknown_username main string unset
15317 See &%unknown_login%&.
15319 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15320 .cindex "trusted users"
15321 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15322 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15323 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15324 .cindex "envelope sender"
15325 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15326 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15327 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15328 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15329 is used) is ignored.
15331 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15332 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15334 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15336 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15337 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15338 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15339 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15340 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15341 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15342 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15343 followed by a hyphen
15344 by a setting like this:
15346 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15348 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15349 restriction, you can use
15351 untrusted_set_sender = *
15353 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15354 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15355 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15356 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15357 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15358 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15359 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15360 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15362 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15363 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15364 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15365 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15369 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15370 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15371 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15372 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15373 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15374 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15375 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15376 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15377 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15378 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15380 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15381 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15383 The pattern can be seen by running
15385 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15387 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15388 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15389 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15390 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15391 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15392 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15395 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15396 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15399 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15400 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15401 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15402 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15403 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15404 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15405 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15406 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15409 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15410 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15411 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15412 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15413 .ecindex IIDconfima
15414 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15422 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15423 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15424 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15425 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15426 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15428 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15429 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15430 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15431 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15432 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15436 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15437 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15438 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15439 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15440 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15441 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15442 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15444 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15445 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15446 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15447 routers, and the eventual transport.
15449 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15450 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15451 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15452 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15453 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15455 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15456 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15457 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15458 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15459 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15461 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15462 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15463 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15465 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15467 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15469 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15471 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15472 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15474 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15475 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15476 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15477 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15478 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15479 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15480 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15484 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15486 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15487 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15488 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15489 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15490 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15495 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15496 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15497 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15498 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15499 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15500 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15501 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15502 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15503 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15504 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15507 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15509 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15512 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15514 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15515 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15516 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15517 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15520 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15521 .cindex "case of local parts"
15522 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15523 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15524 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15525 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15526 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15527 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15528 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15531 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15532 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15533 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15534 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15535 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15536 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15537 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15538 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15539 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15541 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15542 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15543 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15544 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15548 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15549 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15550 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15551 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15553 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15554 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15555 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15556 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15557 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15558 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15559 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15560 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15561 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15562 the router is skipped.
15564 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15565 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15566 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15567 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15568 setting to achieve this. For example:
15570 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15572 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15573 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15574 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15578 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15579 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15580 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15581 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15582 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15583 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15584 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15585 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15587 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15588 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15590 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15591 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15592 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15594 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15596 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15598 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15600 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15601 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15602 be specified using &%condition%&.
15606 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15607 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15608 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15609 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15610 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15611 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15612 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15613 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15614 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15615 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15616 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15617 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15621 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15622 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15623 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15624 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15625 transport option of the same name.
15628 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15629 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15630 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15631 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15632 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15633 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15634 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15635 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15639 .option driver routers string unset
15640 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15645 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15646 .cindex "envelope sender"
15647 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15648 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15649 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15650 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15651 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15652 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15653 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15655 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15656 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15657 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15660 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15661 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15662 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15663 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15665 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15666 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15667 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15668 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15674 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15675 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15676 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15677 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15678 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15680 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15681 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15682 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15683 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15684 setting &%return_path%&.
15686 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15687 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15688 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15692 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15693 .cindex "address" "testing"
15694 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15695 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15696 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15697 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15698 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15699 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15700 on for the system alias file.
15701 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15704 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15705 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15706 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15710 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15711 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15712 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15713 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15717 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15718 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15719 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15723 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15724 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15725 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15729 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15730 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15731 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15732 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15733 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15734 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15735 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15736 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15737 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15739 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15740 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15741 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15742 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15743 transport for further details.
15746 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15747 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15748 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15749 .cindex "transport" "local"
15750 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15751 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15752 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15754 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15755 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15756 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15757 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15758 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15762 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15763 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15764 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15765 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15766 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15767 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15768 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15769 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15770 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15771 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15772 &"see"& the added header lines.
15774 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15775 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15776 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15777 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15779 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15780 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15782 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15783 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15784 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15785 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15786 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15787 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15788 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15789 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15790 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15791 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15795 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15796 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15797 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15798 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15799 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15800 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15801 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15802 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15803 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15804 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15805 &"see"& the original header lines.
15807 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15808 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15809 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15812 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15813 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15815 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15816 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15817 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15818 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15821 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15822 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15823 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15824 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15825 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15826 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15827 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15830 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15834 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15836 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15837 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15838 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15839 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15840 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15841 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15843 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15844 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15846 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15847 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15849 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15850 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15852 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15853 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15854 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15855 domain that is being routed.
15857 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15858 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15861 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15862 .cindex "additional groups"
15863 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15864 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15865 .cindex "transport" "local"
15866 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15867 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15868 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15869 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15870 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15874 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15875 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15876 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15877 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15878 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15879 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15882 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15883 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15884 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15885 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15886 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15887 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15888 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15889 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15890 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15892 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15893 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15894 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15895 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15896 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15897 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15898 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15899 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15900 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15901 the relevant transport.
15903 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15904 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15905 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15908 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15909 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15910 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15911 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15912 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15916 local_part_prefix = real-
15918 transport = local_delivery
15920 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15921 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15923 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15924 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15927 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15928 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15929 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15930 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15933 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15934 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15938 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15939 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15940 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15941 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15942 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15943 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15944 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15945 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15946 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15950 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15951 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15955 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15956 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15957 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15958 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15959 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15961 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15962 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15965 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15967 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
15968 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15969 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
15970 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15971 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15972 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15973 each virtual domain:
15977 local_parts = postmaster
15978 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15982 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
15983 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
15984 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
15985 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
15986 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
15987 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
15988 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
15989 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
15990 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
15991 redirect addresses.
15995 .option more routers boolean&!! true
15996 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15997 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
15998 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
15999 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16000 delivery to be deferred.
16002 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16003 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16005 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16006 means of the setting
16010 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16011 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16012 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16014 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16015 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16016 controls what happens next.
16019 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16020 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16021 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16022 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16023 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16024 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16025 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16026 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16028 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16029 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16030 applies to all of them.
16034 .option pass_router routers string unset
16035 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16036 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16037 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16038 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16039 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16040 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16041 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16042 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16043 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16044 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16048 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16049 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16050 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16051 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16052 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16053 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16055 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16056 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16057 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16058 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16062 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16063 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16064 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16065 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16066 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16067 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16068 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16070 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16071 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16072 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16073 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16075 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16076 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16077 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16078 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16079 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16082 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16083 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16086 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16087 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16088 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16089 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16090 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16091 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16092 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16093 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16095 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16096 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16097 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16098 operates as follows:
16100 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16101 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16102 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16103 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16106 require_files = mail:/some/file
16107 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16109 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16110 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16112 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16113 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16114 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16115 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16117 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16118 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16119 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16120 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16121 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16123 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16124 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16125 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16126 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16127 check again in that process.
16129 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16130 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16131 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16132 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16133 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16134 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16135 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16137 require_files = +/some/file
16139 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16140 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16141 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16145 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16146 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16147 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16148 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16149 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16150 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16151 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16152 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16155 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16156 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16157 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16158 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16159 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16162 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16163 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16164 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16168 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16169 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16170 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16172 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16173 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16174 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16175 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16176 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16177 cause the router to defer.
16179 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16180 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16182 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16184 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16185 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16187 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16188 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16189 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16190 of these values that is set:
16193 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16195 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16197 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16199 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16202 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16203 router, but not for the transport.
16207 .option self routers string freeze
16208 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16209 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16210 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16211 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16212 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16213 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16215 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16216 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16217 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16218 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16219 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16221 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16222 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16223 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16224 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16225 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16230 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16232 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16233 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16234 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16235 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16237 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16238 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16239 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16244 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16245 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16246 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16247 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16248 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16249 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16255 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16256 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16257 be passed to the next router.
16260 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16263 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16264 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16265 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16266 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16267 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16268 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16273 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16274 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16275 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16276 address matches something on the list.
16277 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16280 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16281 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16282 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16283 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16284 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16285 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16286 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16290 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16291 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16292 .cindex "packet radio"
16293 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16294 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16295 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16296 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16297 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16298 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16299 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16300 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16302 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16303 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16304 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16305 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16306 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16307 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16308 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16309 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16310 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16311 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16313 translate_ip_address = \
16314 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16317 The file would contain lines like
16319 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16320 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16322 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16327 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16328 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16329 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16330 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16331 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16332 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16333 delivery is deferred.
16335 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16336 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16337 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16341 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16342 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16343 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16344 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16345 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16346 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16347 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16348 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16349 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16350 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16351 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16357 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16358 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16359 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16360 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16361 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16362 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16363 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16364 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16365 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16366 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16368 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16369 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16370 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16371 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16372 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16374 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16380 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16381 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16382 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16383 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16384 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16385 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16386 delivery to be deferred.
16388 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16389 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16390 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16391 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16392 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16393 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16395 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16396 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16397 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16398 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16399 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16400 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16401 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16402 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16404 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16405 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16406 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16407 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16408 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16409 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16410 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16411 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16412 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16413 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16415 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16416 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16417 subsequent routers.
16420 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16421 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16422 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16423 .cindex "transport" "local"
16424 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16425 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16426 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16427 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16428 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16429 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16430 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16431 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16432 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16433 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16434 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16435 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16439 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16440 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16441 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16444 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16445 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16447 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16448 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16449 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16450 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16451 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16452 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16454 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16455 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16456 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16460 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16461 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16463 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16464 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16468 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16469 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16470 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16471 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16473 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16474 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16484 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16485 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16486 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16487 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16488 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16489 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16490 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16491 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16492 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16496 domains = mydomain.example
16498 transport = local_delivery
16500 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16501 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16502 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16503 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16513 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16514 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16515 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16516 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16517 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16518 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16520 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16521 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16522 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16523 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16526 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16527 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16528 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16529 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16530 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16531 generic option, the router declines.
16533 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16534 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16535 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16537 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16538 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16539 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16540 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16541 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16542 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16545 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16546 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16547 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16548 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16549 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16550 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16552 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16553 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16554 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16555 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16556 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16557 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16558 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16559 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16560 case routing fails.
16565 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16566 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16567 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16569 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16570 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16571 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16572 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16573 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16574 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16575 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16578 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16579 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16580 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16581 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16582 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16583 required. For example,
16587 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16588 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16589 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16590 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16591 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16594 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16595 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16596 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16597 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16598 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16599 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16601 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16602 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16603 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16604 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16605 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16606 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16607 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16608 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16610 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16611 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16615 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16616 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16617 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16618 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16619 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16620 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16621 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16624 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16626 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16627 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16628 the address record.
16631 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16632 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16633 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16634 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16639 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16640 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16641 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16642 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16643 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16644 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16645 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16646 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16647 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16652 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16653 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16654 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16655 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16656 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16657 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16658 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16659 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16660 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16661 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16662 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16664 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16665 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16668 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16669 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16670 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16671 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16672 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16676 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16677 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16678 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16679 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16680 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16681 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16682 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16683 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16685 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16686 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16687 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16688 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16689 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16690 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16691 without processing them independently,
16692 provided the following conditions are met:
16695 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16696 &%headers_remove%&.
16698 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16705 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16706 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16707 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16708 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16709 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16710 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16711 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16712 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16713 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16714 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16716 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16717 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16722 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16723 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16724 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16725 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16730 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16731 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16732 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16733 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16736 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16738 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16739 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16740 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16741 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16742 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16743 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16746 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16747 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16748 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16749 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16750 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16752 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16753 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16754 such as that implied by
16758 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16759 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16760 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16761 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16774 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16775 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16776 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16777 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16778 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16779 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16780 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16781 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16782 router handles the address
16786 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16787 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16788 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16790 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16792 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16793 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16795 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16796 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16797 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16798 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16800 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16801 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16802 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16803 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16810 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16811 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16812 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16813 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16814 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16815 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16818 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16820 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16822 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16823 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16824 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16825 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16826 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16827 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16828 must not be specified for it.
16830 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16831 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16832 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16833 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16834 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16835 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16836 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16839 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16840 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16841 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16842 delivery to the address is deferred.
16845 .option port iplookup integer 0
16846 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16847 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16851 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16852 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16853 protocols is to be used.
16856 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16857 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16860 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16862 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16863 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16866 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16867 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16868 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16869 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16870 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16871 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16872 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16873 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16876 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16877 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16878 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16879 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16880 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16881 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16882 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16883 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16884 following could be used:
16886 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16887 reroute = $local_part@$1
16890 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16891 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16892 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16893 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16901 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16902 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16903 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16904 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16905 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16906 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16907 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16908 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16909 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16910 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16912 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16913 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16914 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16915 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16916 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16917 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16918 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16921 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16922 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16923 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16924 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16925 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16926 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16927 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16930 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16931 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16932 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16933 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16934 below, following the list of private options.
16937 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16939 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16940 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16942 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16943 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16945 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16946 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16947 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16948 of the following values:
16957 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16958 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
16959 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
16962 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
16963 router only if &%more%& is true.
16965 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
16966 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
16967 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
16968 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
16970 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
16971 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
16972 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
16975 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
16976 .cindex "randomized host list"
16977 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
16978 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16979 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16980 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16981 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16982 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16983 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16984 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
16986 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
16987 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
16988 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
16989 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
16991 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
16993 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
16994 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
16995 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
16996 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
16997 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17000 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17001 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17002 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17005 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17007 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17008 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17012 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17013 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17014 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17015 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17018 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17019 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17020 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17021 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17022 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17023 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17024 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17025 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17027 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17028 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17029 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17030 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17031 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17032 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17033 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17034 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17039 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17040 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17041 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17042 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17043 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17044 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17046 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17048 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17052 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17053 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17055 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17056 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17057 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17058 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17059 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17060 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17061 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17062 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17063 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17064 in a &%route_list%&).
17066 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17067 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17068 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17069 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17073 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17074 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17075 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17076 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17077 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17078 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17079 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17082 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17083 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17085 This data can be accessed by setting
17087 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17089 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17090 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17091 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17092 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17093 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17098 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17099 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17100 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17101 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17102 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17103 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17104 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17106 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17107 variables are set during its expansion:
17110 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17111 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17112 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17114 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17117 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17119 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17122 .vindex "&$value$&"
17123 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17124 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17126 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17130 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17131 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17135 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17136 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17137 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17138 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17139 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17140 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17143 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17144 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17145 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17147 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17148 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17151 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17152 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17153 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17154 number follows. For example:
17156 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17160 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17161 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17162 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17163 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17164 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17167 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17168 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17169 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17170 records in the DNS. For example:
17172 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17174 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17177 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17179 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17180 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17181 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17182 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17183 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17184 happens is controlled by the
17185 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17186 &%self%& option of the router.
17188 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17189 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17190 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17191 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17192 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17193 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17194 defined by MX preferences.
17196 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17197 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17198 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17200 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17201 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17202 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17203 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17205 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17206 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17209 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17210 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17211 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17213 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17214 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17218 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17219 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17220 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17221 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17222 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17223 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17224 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17227 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17228 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17230 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17231 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17233 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17234 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17235 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17237 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17238 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17239 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17244 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17245 domain2 host4:host5
17247 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17248 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17249 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17250 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17253 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17254 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17255 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17256 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17261 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17262 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17265 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17266 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17270 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17271 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17272 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17275 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17276 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17277 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17278 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17280 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17282 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17283 your first router something like this:
17286 driver = manualroute
17287 domains = !+local_domains
17288 transport = remote_smtp
17289 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17291 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17292 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17293 they are tried in order
17294 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17295 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17298 driver = manualroute
17299 transport = remote_smtp
17300 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17302 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17303 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17304 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17305 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17306 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17307 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17308 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17309 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17312 .cindex "mail hub example"
17313 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17314 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17315 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17316 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17317 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17318 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17319 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17320 lookup is easier to manage.
17322 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17323 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17327 driver = manualroute
17328 transport = remote_smtp
17329 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17331 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17332 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17333 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17334 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17335 domain can be used to find the host:
17338 driver = manualroute
17339 transport = remote_smtp
17340 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17342 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17343 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17344 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17348 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17349 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17350 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17351 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17352 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17353 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17356 driver = manualroute
17357 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17358 route_list = saved.domain.example
17360 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17361 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17362 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17365 driver = manualroute
17367 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17368 *.saved.domain2.example \
17369 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17372 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17374 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17375 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17376 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17377 the address if the lookup fails.
17380 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17381 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17382 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17383 one way it can be done:
17389 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17390 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17391 return_fail_output = true
17396 driver = manualroute
17398 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17400 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17402 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17404 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17405 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17406 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17408 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17409 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17421 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17422 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17423 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17424 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17425 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17426 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17427 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17428 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17429 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17430 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17432 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17434 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17435 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17436 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17437 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17438 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17441 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17442 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17443 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17444 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17445 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17446 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17449 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17450 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17451 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17452 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17453 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17454 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17455 not set, a value for the gid also.
17457 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17458 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17459 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17460 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17461 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17462 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17466 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17467 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17468 before running the command.
17471 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17472 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17473 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17477 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17478 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17479 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17480 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17481 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17484 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17487 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17488 &%no_more%& is set.
17490 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17491 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17492 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17493 included in the SMTP response.
17495 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17496 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17497 included in any SMTP response.
17499 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17501 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17502 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17504 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17505 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17506 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17509 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17510 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17513 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17514 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17516 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17517 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17518 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17519 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17521 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17522 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17523 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17524 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17525 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17527 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17528 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17529 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17530 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17531 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17533 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17534 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17535 variable. For example, this return line
17537 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17539 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17540 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17541 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17542 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17550 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17551 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17552 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17553 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17554 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17555 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17556 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17557 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17558 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17559 redirected in several different ways:
17562 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17565 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17567 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17569 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17571 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17573 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17575 It can be discarded.
17578 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17579 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17580 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17581 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17585 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17586 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17587 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17588 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17589 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17590 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17594 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17596 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17597 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17598 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17599 cause delivery to be deferred.
17601 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17602 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17607 file = $home/.forward
17610 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17611 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17612 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17613 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17618 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17619 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17620 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17621 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17624 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17625 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17626 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17627 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17629 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17630 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17631 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17632 saves some resources.
17640 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17641 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17642 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17643 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17644 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17647 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17648 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17649 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17650 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17651 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17652 document is intended for use by end users.
17654 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17655 described in the next section.
17658 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17659 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17660 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17661 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17662 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17666 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17667 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17668 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17669 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17670 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17671 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17672 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17673 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17674 commas or newlines.
17675 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17678 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17679 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17680 next newline character is ignored.
17682 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17683 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17684 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17685 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17688 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17689 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17690 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17691 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17692 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17693 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17696 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17700 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17701 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17702 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17703 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17704 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17705 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17706 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17707 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17708 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17709 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17710 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17712 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17713 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17714 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17715 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17716 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17718 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17720 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17721 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17722 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17723 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17724 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17727 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17728 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17729 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17730 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17731 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17733 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17734 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17739 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17740 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17743 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17745 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17746 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17747 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17748 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17749 should really contain
17751 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17753 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17754 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17755 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17759 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17760 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17761 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17764 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17765 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17766 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17767 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17768 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17769 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17770 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17772 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17773 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17774 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17775 in double quotes, for example:
17777 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17779 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17780 quote just the command. An item such as
17782 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17784 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17787 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17788 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17789 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17790 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17792 /home/world/minbari
17794 is treated as a file name, but
17796 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17798 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17799 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17800 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17801 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17803 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17804 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17806 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17807 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17808 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17809 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17812 .cindex "included address list"
17813 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17814 If an item is of the form
17816 :include:<path name>
17818 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17819 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17820 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17821 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17822 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17823 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17825 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17827 It must be given as
17829 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17832 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17833 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17834 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17835 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17836 .cindex "black hole"
17837 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17838 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17839 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17840 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17842 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17843 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17844 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17845 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17849 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17850 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17851 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17852 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17853 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17854 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17855 redirection items of the form
17860 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17861 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
17862 different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
17863 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17865 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17867 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17869 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17870 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17872 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17873 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17874 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17876 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17877 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17878 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17879 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17880 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17881 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17882 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17883 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17884 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17887 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17888 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17889 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17890 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17892 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17893 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17894 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17895 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17896 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17898 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17899 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17900 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17901 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17902 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17906 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17907 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17908 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17909 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17910 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17911 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17912 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17916 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17917 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17918 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17919 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17920 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17921 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17922 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17923 aliasing scheme of the type
17925 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17929 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17930 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17931 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17934 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17935 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17937 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17938 the pipes are distinct.
17942 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17943 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17944 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17945 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17946 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17947 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17948 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17949 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17950 can be used to avoid this.
17953 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17954 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17955 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17956 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17957 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17958 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17959 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
17963 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
17965 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
17966 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
17969 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
17970 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
17971 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
17974 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
17975 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
17976 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
17977 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
17980 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
17981 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
17982 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
17983 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
17984 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
17985 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
17986 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
17988 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
17989 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
17992 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
17993 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
17994 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
17995 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
17996 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18000 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18001 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18002 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18003 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18004 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18005 let ordinary users do.
18009 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18010 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18011 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18012 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18013 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18014 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18016 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18017 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18018 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18019 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18020 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18021 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18023 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18025 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18026 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18027 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18028 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18029 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18030 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18031 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18032 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18035 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18036 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18037 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18038 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18039 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18040 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18041 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18042 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18046 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18047 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18048 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18049 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18050 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18051 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18054 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18055 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18056 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18057 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18058 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18059 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18061 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18062 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18063 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18065 data = #Exim filter\n\
18066 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18068 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18069 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18070 choice into a newline.
18073 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18074 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18075 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18076 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18077 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18080 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18081 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18082 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18083 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18084 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18085 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18086 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18087 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18089 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18090 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18091 runs a check on the containing directory,
18092 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18093 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18094 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18095 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18096 not, the router declines.
18099 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18100 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18101 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18102 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18103 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18104 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18105 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18108 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18109 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18110 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18111 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18112 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18115 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18116 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18120 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18121 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18122 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18127 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18128 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18129 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18130 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18131 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18132 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18133 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18134 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18135 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18138 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18139 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18140 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18141 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18144 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18145 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18146 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18147 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18149 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18150 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18151 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18152 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18153 &_.forward_& files).
18156 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18157 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18158 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18161 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18162 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18163 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18164 of the embedded Perl support.
18167 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18168 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18169 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18172 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18173 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18174 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18177 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18178 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18179 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18180 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18181 &%one_time%& is set.
18184 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18185 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18186 to make use of &%run%& items.
18189 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18190 If this option is true, items of the form
18192 :include:<path name>
18194 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18197 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18198 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18199 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18200 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18201 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18204 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18205 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18206 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18209 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18210 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18211 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18212 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18213 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18218 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18219 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18220 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18221 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18222 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18223 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18224 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18227 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18229 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18230 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18231 file did not exist.
18234 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18236 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18237 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18238 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18240 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18241 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18242 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18243 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18244 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18245 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18246 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18247 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18251 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18252 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18253 redirection list must start with this directory.
18256 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18257 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18258 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18261 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18262 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18263 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18264 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18265 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18266 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18267 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18268 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18269 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18270 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18271 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18272 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18273 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18274 before they subscribed.
18276 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18277 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18278 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18279 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18282 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18283 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18284 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18285 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18287 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18288 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18289 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18291 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18294 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18295 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18296 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18297 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18298 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18302 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18303 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18304 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18305 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18306 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18307 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18308 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18309 See &%check_owner%& above.
18312 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18313 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18314 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18315 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18318 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18319 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18320 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18321 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18322 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18323 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18324 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18327 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18328 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18329 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18330 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18331 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18332 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18333 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18334 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18336 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18337 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18338 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18341 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18342 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18343 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18344 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18345 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18346 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18347 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18348 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18349 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18350 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18353 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18354 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18355 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18356 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18357 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18358 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18361 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18362 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18363 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18364 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18365 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18366 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18369 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18370 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18371 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18372 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18373 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18376 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18377 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18378 :subaddress part of an address.
18380 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18381 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18382 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18383 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18386 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18387 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18388 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18389 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18390 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18391 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18392 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18396 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18397 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18398 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18399 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18400 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18401 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18402 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18403 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18404 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18405 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18406 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18407 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18408 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18409 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18410 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18411 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18413 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18414 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18415 the following routers.
18417 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18418 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18419 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18420 so it is passed to the following routers.
18422 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18423 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18424 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18425 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18427 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18428 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18429 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18430 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18436 file = $home/.forward
18437 file_transport = address_file
18438 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18439 reply_transport = address_reply
18442 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18443 syntax_errors_text = \
18444 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18445 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18446 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18447 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18448 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18449 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18450 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18451 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18452 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18453 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18455 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18456 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18457 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18462 local_part_prefix = real-
18463 transport = local_delivery
18465 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18466 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18468 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18469 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18473 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18474 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18477 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18478 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18479 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18480 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18490 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18491 "Environment for local transports"
18492 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18493 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18494 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18495 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18496 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18497 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18498 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18500 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18501 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18502 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18503 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18505 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18506 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18507 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18508 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18509 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18513 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18514 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18515 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18516 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18517 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18518 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18519 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18522 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18523 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18527 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18529 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18530 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18531 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18532 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18537 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18538 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18539 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18540 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18541 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18542 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18543 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18544 group (set by the transport). For example:
18547 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18551 transport = group_delivery
18554 # This transport overrides the group
18556 driver = appendfile
18557 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18560 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18561 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18562 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18565 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18566 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18567 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18568 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18569 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18570 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18572 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18573 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18574 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18575 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18576 original gid is also used.
18578 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18579 following that is set is used:
18582 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18584 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18586 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18587 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18589 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18591 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18592 the uid is the creator's uid;
18594 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18597 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18598 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18599 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18600 The first of the following that is set is used:
18603 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18605 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18607 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18609 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18614 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18615 &%never_users%& list.
18621 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18622 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18623 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18624 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18625 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18626 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18627 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18628 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18629 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18630 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18633 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18635 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18637 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18639 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18642 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18645 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18647 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18651 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18652 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18653 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18657 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18658 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18659 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18660 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18661 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18662 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18663 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18664 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18665 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18666 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18667 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18668 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18669 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18670 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18681 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18682 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18683 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18684 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18685 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18688 .option body_only transports boolean false
18689 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18690 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18691 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18692 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18693 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18694 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18695 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18696 automatically suppress them.
18699 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18700 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18701 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18702 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18703 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18704 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18707 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18708 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18709 deliveries by the transport or for any
18710 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18711 what you are doing.
18714 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18715 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18716 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18717 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18719 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18720 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18721 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18722 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18723 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18724 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18728 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18729 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18730 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18731 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18732 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18733 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18734 safely be resent to other recipients.
18737 .option driver transports string unset
18738 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18739 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18742 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18743 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18744 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18745 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18746 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18747 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18748 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18749 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18750 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18751 resent to other recipients.
18754 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18755 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18756 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18757 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18758 &%user%& (see below).
18761 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18762 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18763 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18764 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18765 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18766 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18767 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18768 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18769 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18773 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18774 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18775 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18776 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18777 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18778 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18779 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18780 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18783 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18784 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18785 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18786 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18787 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18788 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18789 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18790 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18791 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18795 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18796 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18797 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18798 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18799 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18800 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18801 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18802 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18805 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18808 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18809 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18810 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18811 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18812 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18813 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18814 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18815 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18816 change envelope recipients at this time.
18819 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18820 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18822 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18823 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18824 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18825 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18826 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18827 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18828 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18832 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18833 .cindex "additional groups"
18834 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18835 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18836 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18837 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18838 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18841 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18842 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18843 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18844 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18845 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18846 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18847 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18848 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18849 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18850 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18851 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18852 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18853 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18858 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18859 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18860 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18861 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18862 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18863 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18864 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18865 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18868 local_part_prefix = *-
18870 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18873 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18875 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18876 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18877 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18878 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18879 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18882 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18883 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18884 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18885 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18886 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18887 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18888 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18889 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18890 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18892 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18893 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18894 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18895 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18897 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18898 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18899 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18902 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18903 .cindex "envelope sender"
18904 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18905 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18906 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18907 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18908 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18909 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18910 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18911 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18912 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18914 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18915 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18917 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18918 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18919 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18920 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18921 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18922 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18923 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18925 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18926 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18927 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18928 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18929 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18933 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18934 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18935 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18936 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18937 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18938 have easy access to it.
18940 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18941 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18942 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18943 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18944 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18948 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18949 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18952 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18953 .cindex "shadow transport"
18954 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18955 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18956 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18958 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18959 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18960 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
18961 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
18962 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
18963 cause a log line to be written.
18965 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18966 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18967 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
18968 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
18969 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
18972 ST=<shadow transport name>
18974 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18975 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
18976 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
18977 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
18978 headers that some sites insist on.
18981 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
18982 .cindex "transport" "filter"
18983 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
18984 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
18985 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
18986 individual users or via a system filter.
18988 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
18989 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
18990 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
18991 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
18992 command must be specified as an absolute path.
18994 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
18995 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
18996 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
18997 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
18998 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
18999 &(pipe)& transports.
19001 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19002 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19003 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19004 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19005 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19007 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19008 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
19009 &_util/transport-filter.pl_&; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
19010 show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
19011 final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
19012 with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19014 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19015 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19016 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19017 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19018 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19019 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19021 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19022 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19023 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19024 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19025 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19026 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19027 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19028 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19030 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19031 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19032 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19033 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19034 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19035 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19036 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19037 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19038 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19039 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19042 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19043 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19044 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19045 which the message is being sent. For example:
19047 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19048 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19051 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19052 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19053 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19055 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19056 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19057 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19060 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19062 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19063 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19064 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19065 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19066 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19067 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19069 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19070 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19071 arguments. Consider this example:
19073 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19074 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19076 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19077 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19079 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19080 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19084 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19085 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19086 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19087 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19088 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19089 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19090 bounced from a transport filter.
19092 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19093 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19094 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19097 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19098 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19099 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19100 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19101 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19102 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19103 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19104 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19105 becomes a temporary error.
19108 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19109 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19110 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19111 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19112 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19113 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19114 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19117 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19118 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19119 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19121 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19122 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19123 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19124 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19126 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19127 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19128 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19138 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19140 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19141 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19142 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19143 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19144 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19145 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19146 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19148 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19149 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19150 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19151 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19152 local transport, for example:
19155 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19156 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19157 recipients saves space.
19159 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19160 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19162 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19163 to a scanner program or
19164 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19168 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19169 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19170 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19172 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19173 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19174 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19175 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19176 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19177 to certain conditions:
19180 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19181 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19182 batching is possible.
19184 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19185 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19186 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19188 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19189 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19190 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19191 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19192 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19195 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19196 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19197 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19201 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19202 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19203 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19204 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19205 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19206 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19207 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19210 escape_string = ".."
19212 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19213 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19214 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19216 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19217 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19218 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19219 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19220 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19221 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19223 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19224 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19225 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19226 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19227 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19228 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19229 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19230 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19231 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19239 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19240 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19241 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19242 .cindex "directory creation"
19243 .cindex "creating directories"
19244 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19245 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19246 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19247 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19248 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19249 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19250 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19251 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19252 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19253 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19255 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19256 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19257 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19260 .cindex "quota" "system"
19261 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19262 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19263 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19265 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19266 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19267 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19268 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19270 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19271 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19274 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19275 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19276 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19277 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19282 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19283 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19284 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19285 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19286 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19288 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19289 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19290 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19291 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19292 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19293 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19294 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19295 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19296 operation. There are two cases:
19299 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19300 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19301 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19302 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19303 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19304 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19305 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19307 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19308 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19309 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19313 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19314 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19315 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19316 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19321 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19323 require "fileinto";
19324 fileinto "folder23";
19326 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19327 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19328 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19329 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19330 way of handling this requirement:
19332 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19333 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19334 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19336 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19340 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19341 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19342 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19344 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19345 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19346 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19347 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19348 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19349 path to the transport.
19351 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19352 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19357 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19358 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19362 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19363 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19364 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19365 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19366 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19367 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19368 delivery is deferred.
19371 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19372 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19373 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19374 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19375 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19376 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19377 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19378 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19381 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19382 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19383 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19384 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19388 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19389 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19392 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19393 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19394 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19395 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19396 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19399 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19400 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19401 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19402 process is running.
19405 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19406 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19407 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19408 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19409 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19410 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19411 contains is significant.
19413 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19414 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19415 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19416 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19417 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19419 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19420 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19421 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19422 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19423 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19424 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19426 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19427 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19428 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19429 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19431 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19432 .cindex "directory creation"
19433 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19434 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19435 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19437 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19438 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19439 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19440 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19441 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19445 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19446 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19447 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19448 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19449 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19452 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19453 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19454 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19455 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19456 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19457 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19458 &%file_must_exist%&.
19461 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19462 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19463 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19464 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19466 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19467 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19468 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19469 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19470 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19473 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19475 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19476 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19477 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19478 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19480 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19482 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19483 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19487 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19488 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19489 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19492 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19493 See &%check_string%& above.
19496 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19497 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19498 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19499 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19500 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19501 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19504 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19505 .cindex "locking files"
19506 .cindex "lock files"
19507 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19508 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19510 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19511 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19514 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19515 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19518 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19519 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19520 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19521 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19522 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19523 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19527 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19528 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19529 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19530 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19531 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19532 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19533 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19534 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19535 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19538 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19539 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19541 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19542 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19543 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19544 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19545 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19546 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19547 delivery is deferred.
19550 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19551 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19552 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19553 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19556 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19557 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19558 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19559 .cindex "locking files"
19560 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19561 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19562 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19563 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19564 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19565 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19566 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19567 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19569 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19570 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19571 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19572 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19574 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19575 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19578 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19580 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19581 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19582 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19584 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19585 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19587 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19590 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19591 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19592 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19593 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19596 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19597 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19598 for details of locking.
19601 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19602 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19603 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19606 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19607 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19608 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19611 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19612 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19613 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19614 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19615 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19618 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19619 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19620 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19621 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19622 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19623 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19624 external source that maintains the data.
19627 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19628 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19629 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19630 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19631 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19632 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19633 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19634 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19638 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19639 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19640 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19641 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19642 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19643 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19644 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19645 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19646 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19647 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19650 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19651 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19652 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19653 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19654 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19655 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19656 calculation. The default value is:
19658 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19660 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19661 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19663 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19665 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19667 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19668 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19669 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19670 directly into that directory.
19673 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19674 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19675 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19678 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19679 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19680 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19683 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19684 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19685 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19686 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19687 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19688 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19689 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19691 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19692 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19693 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19694 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19695 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19696 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19697 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19698 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19699 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19700 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19703 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19704 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19705 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19706 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19707 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19708 below for further details.
19711 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19712 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19713 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19716 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19717 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19718 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19721 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19722 .cindex "locking files"
19723 .cindex "file" "locking"
19724 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19725 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19726 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19727 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19728 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19729 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19730 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19732 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19733 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19734 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19741 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19742 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19743 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19744 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19745 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19746 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19747 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19748 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19750 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19751 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19752 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19753 append messages to it.
19756 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19757 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19758 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19759 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19760 in which case it is:
19762 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19763 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19765 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19766 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19768 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19769 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19770 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19771 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19776 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19777 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19779 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19780 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19781 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19782 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19783 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19784 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19785 value, and this option is ignored.
19788 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19789 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19790 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19791 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19792 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19795 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19796 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19797 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19798 on users about incoming mail.
19801 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19802 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19803 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19804 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19805 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19806 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19807 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19808 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19809 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19811 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19812 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19813 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19815 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19816 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19817 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19818 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19819 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19820 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19822 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19823 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19824 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19825 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19828 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19830 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19831 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19832 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19833 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19834 system quota failures.
19836 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19837 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19838 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19839 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19840 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19841 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19842 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19843 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19844 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19845 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19848 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19849 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19850 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19851 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19852 delivery directory.
19855 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19856 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19857 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19858 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19859 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19863 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19864 See &%quota%& above.
19867 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19868 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19869 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19870 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19871 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19872 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19873 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19875 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19876 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19877 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19878 the file length to the file name. For example:
19880 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19881 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19883 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19884 number of lines in the message.
19886 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19887 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19888 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19892 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19893 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19894 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19896 quota_warn_message = "\
19897 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19898 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19899 This message is automatically created \
19900 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19901 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19902 a warning threshold that is\n\
19903 set by the system administrator.\n"
19907 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19908 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19909 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19910 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19911 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19912 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19913 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19914 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19915 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19919 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19921 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19922 percent sign is ignored.
19924 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19925 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19926 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19927 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19928 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19929 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19931 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19933 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19934 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19937 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19938 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19942 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19943 .cindex "envelope sender"
19944 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19945 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19946 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19947 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19948 for details of batch SMTP.
19951 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19952 .cindex "carriage return"
19954 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19955 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19956 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19957 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19959 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
19960 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
19961 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
19962 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
19963 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
19964 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
19967 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19968 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
19969 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19970 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19971 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
19972 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
19975 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
19976 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
19977 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19978 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
19979 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
19981 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19982 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
19983 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
19984 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
19986 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
19987 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
19988 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
19989 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
19990 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
19993 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
19994 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
19997 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
19998 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
19999 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20000 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20001 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20002 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20003 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20005 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20006 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20007 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20008 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20011 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20012 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20013 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20016 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20017 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20018 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20019 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20020 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20021 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20022 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20023 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20024 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20026 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20027 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20028 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20029 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20034 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20035 .cindex "appending to a file"
20036 .cindex "file" "appending"
20037 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20040 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20044 .cindex "directory creation"
20045 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20046 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20047 &%directory_mode%& option.
20050 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20051 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20055 .cindex "file" "locking"
20056 .cindex "locking files"
20057 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20058 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20059 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20062 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20063 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20064 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20066 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20068 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20069 Unlink the hitching post name.
20071 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20072 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20073 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20074 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20076 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20077 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20078 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20079 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20080 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20081 it before trying again.
20085 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20086 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20087 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20090 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20091 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20092 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20093 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20094 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20095 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20096 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20097 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20098 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20102 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20103 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20104 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20105 delivery is deferred.
20108 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20109 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20110 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20114 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20115 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20116 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20119 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20120 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20121 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20124 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20125 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20126 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20127 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20128 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20129 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20130 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20131 that prevents link following.
20134 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20135 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20136 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20137 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20138 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20141 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20144 .cindex "file" "locking"
20145 .cindex "locking files"
20146 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20147 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20148 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20149 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20150 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20152 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20154 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20155 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20156 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20158 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20159 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20160 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20162 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20163 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20164 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20165 delivery is deferred.
20167 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20168 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20169 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20170 immediately. It retries up to
20172 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20174 times (rounded up).
20177 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20178 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20181 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20182 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20183 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20184 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20185 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20186 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20187 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20188 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20189 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20190 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20192 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20193 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20194 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20195 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20196 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20197 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20198 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20200 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20201 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20202 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20203 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20206 .cindex "maildir format"
20207 .cindex "mailstore format"
20208 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20209 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20210 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20211 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20212 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20214 .cindex "directory creation"
20215 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20216 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20217 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20218 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20219 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20220 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20225 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20226 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20227 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20228 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20229 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20230 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20231 &_new_& subdirectory.
20233 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20234 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20235 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20236 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20237 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20238 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20239 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20241 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20242 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20243 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20244 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20245 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20246 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20247 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20248 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20250 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20251 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20252 folders. Consider this example:
20254 maildir_format = true
20255 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20256 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20257 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20258 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20260 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20261 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20262 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20263 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20264 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20265 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20267 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20268 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20269 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20270 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20271 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20273 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20274 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20275 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20277 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20278 .cindex "maildir++"
20279 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20280 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20281 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20282 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20283 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20284 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20285 amount of space used.
20287 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20288 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20289 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20290 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20291 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20292 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20297 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20298 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20299 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20300 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20301 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20302 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20304 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20305 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20306 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20307 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20308 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20309 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20310 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20311 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20312 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20317 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20318 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20319 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20320 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20321 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20322 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20323 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20324 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20325 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20327 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20328 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20329 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20330 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20331 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20332 need to know the quota.
20334 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20335 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20337 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20338 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20339 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20343 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20344 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20345 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20346 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20347 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20348 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20349 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20350 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20352 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20353 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20354 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20355 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20356 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20357 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20359 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20360 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20361 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20362 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20363 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20364 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20366 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20367 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20368 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20369 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20372 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20373 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20374 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20375 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20376 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20378 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20380 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20381 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20382 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20383 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20384 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20394 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20395 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20396 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20397 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20398 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20399 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20400 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20401 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20403 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20404 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20405 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20406 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20407 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20410 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20411 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20412 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20413 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20414 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20416 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20417 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20418 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20419 transport is run as a consequence of a
20421 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20422 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20423 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20424 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20425 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20426 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20428 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20429 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20430 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20431 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20433 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20434 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20435 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20436 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20437 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20438 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20439 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20441 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20442 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20443 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20444 the transport defers.
20445 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20446 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20448 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20449 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20450 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20451 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20453 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20454 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20455 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20456 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20457 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20458 problems. They are just discarded.
20462 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20463 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20465 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20466 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20467 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20470 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20471 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20472 when the message is specified by the transport.
20475 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20476 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20477 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20478 string comes first.
20481 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20482 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20483 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20486 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20487 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20488 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20491 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20492 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20493 specified by the transport.
20496 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20497 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20498 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20499 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20502 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20503 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20504 the message is specified by the transport.
20507 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20508 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20512 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20513 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20514 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20515 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20516 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20520 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20521 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20522 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20523 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20525 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20526 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20527 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20528 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20529 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20530 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20531 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20534 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20535 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20536 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20537 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20538 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20540 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20541 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20542 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20543 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20544 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20545 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20548 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20549 See &%once%& above.
20552 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20553 See &%once%& above.
20554 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20557 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20558 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20559 specified by the transport.
20562 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20563 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20564 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20565 configuration option.
20568 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20569 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20570 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20571 automatic responses. For example:
20573 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20575 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20576 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20577 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20578 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20583 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20584 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20585 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20586 the text comes first.
20589 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20590 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20591 when the message is specified by the transport.
20592 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20593 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20601 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20602 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20603 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20604 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20605 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20606 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20608 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20609 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20610 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20611 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20612 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20613 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20617 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20618 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20619 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20622 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20623 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20626 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20627 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20628 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20629 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20630 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20633 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20634 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20635 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20636 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20637 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20638 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20641 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20642 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20643 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20644 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20645 in its response to the LHLO command.
20647 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20648 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20649 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20650 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20653 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20654 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20655 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20656 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20661 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20665 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20666 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20673 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20674 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20675 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20676 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20677 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20678 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20679 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20680 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20684 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20685 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20686 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20687 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20688 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20690 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20691 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20692 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20693 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20694 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20695 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20696 that are routed to the transport.
20698 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20699 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20700 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20701 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20702 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20703 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20704 the local part that was redirected.
20708 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20709 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20710 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20712 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20713 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20714 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20715 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20716 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20717 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20718 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20721 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20722 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20723 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20724 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20725 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20730 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20731 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20732 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20733 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20734 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20735 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20736 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20737 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20738 &"local delivery failed"&.
20740 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20741 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20742 value is the return code minus 128.
20744 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20745 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20746 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20747 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20749 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20750 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20751 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20752 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20753 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20754 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20755 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20760 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20761 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20762 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20763 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20764 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20767 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20768 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20769 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20770 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20772 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20773 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20774 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20775 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20776 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20778 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20780 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20781 arguments. You have to write
20783 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20785 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20786 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20787 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20788 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20789 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20790 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20793 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20796 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20797 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20798 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20799 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20800 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20801 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20802 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20803 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20804 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20805 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20807 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20808 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20809 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20810 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20811 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20812 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20813 control what is done with it.
20815 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20816 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20817 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20818 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20819 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20820 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20821 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20822 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20823 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20824 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20825 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20829 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20830 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20831 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20832 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20833 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20834 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20837 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20838 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20839 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20840 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20841 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20842 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20843 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20844 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20845 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20846 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20847 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20848 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20849 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20850 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20851 &`USER `& see below
20853 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20854 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20855 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20856 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20857 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20858 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20859 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20862 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20863 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20864 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20868 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20869 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20870 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20871 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20874 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20875 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20879 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20880 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20881 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20882 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20883 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20884 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20885 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20886 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20887 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20888 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20889 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20892 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20894 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20895 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20896 &%use_shell%& is set.
20899 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20900 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20903 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20904 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20905 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20908 .option check_string pipe string unset
20909 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20910 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20911 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20912 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20913 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20914 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20915 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20919 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20920 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20921 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20922 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20923 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20924 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20925 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20928 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20929 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20930 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20931 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20932 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20933 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20934 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20937 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20938 See &%check_string%& above.
20941 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20942 .cindex "exec failure"
20943 .cindex "failure of exec"
20944 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20945 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20946 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20947 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20948 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
20951 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
20952 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20953 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20954 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
20955 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
20956 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
20958 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
20959 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
20961 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
20962 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
20963 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20964 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
20965 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20968 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
20969 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20970 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20971 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20972 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
20973 Only one of them may be set.
20977 .option log_output pipe boolean false
20978 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20979 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
20980 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
20984 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
20985 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
20986 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
20987 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
20988 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
20989 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
20990 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
20991 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
20994 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
20995 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20996 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
20999 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21003 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21004 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21005 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21006 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21007 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21012 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21013 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21016 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21017 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21018 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21019 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21023 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21024 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21027 .option path pipe string "see below"
21028 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21029 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21033 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21034 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21035 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21038 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21039 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21040 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21041 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21042 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21043 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21044 accept the message is used.
21047 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21048 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21049 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21050 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21051 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21052 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21055 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21056 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21057 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21058 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21059 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21060 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21061 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21065 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21066 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21067 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21068 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21069 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21070 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21071 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21072 of them may be set.
21076 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21077 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21078 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21079 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21080 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21081 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21082 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21083 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21084 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21085 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21086 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21087 and 73, respectively.
21090 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21091 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21092 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21093 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21094 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21095 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21096 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21098 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21099 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21100 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21101 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21102 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21103 delivery to be deferred.
21105 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21106 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21109 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21110 .cindex "envelope sender"
21111 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21112 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21113 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21114 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21115 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21117 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21118 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21119 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21120 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21121 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21122 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21126 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21127 .cindex "carriage return"
21129 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21130 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21131 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21132 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21134 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21135 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21136 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21137 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21138 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21141 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21142 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21143 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21144 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21145 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21146 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21147 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21148 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21149 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21154 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21155 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21156 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21157 .cindex "external local delivery"
21158 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21159 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21160 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21161 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21162 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21163 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21164 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21165 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21166 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21167 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21172 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21176 check_string = "From "
21177 escape_string = ">From "
21185 transport = procmail_pipe
21187 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21188 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21189 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21190 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21191 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21192 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21194 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21198 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21199 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21202 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21203 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21206 local_delivery_cyrus:
21208 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21209 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21221 local_part_suffix = .*
21222 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21224 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21225 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21227 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21228 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21234 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21235 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21236 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21237 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21238 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21239 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21240 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21241 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21244 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21245 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21249 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21250 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21251 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21252 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21253 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21254 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21255 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21257 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21258 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21259 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21260 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21261 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21262 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21267 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21268 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21269 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21273 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21275 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21276 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21277 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21278 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21279 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21280 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21281 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21282 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21285 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21286 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21287 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21288 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21289 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21290 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21291 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21292 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21293 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21294 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21295 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21298 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21299 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21300 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21303 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21304 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21305 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21306 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21307 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21308 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21309 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21310 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21312 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21313 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21314 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21315 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21316 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21317 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21318 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21319 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21320 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21323 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21325 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21326 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21327 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21328 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21329 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21332 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21333 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21334 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21335 particular connection.
21337 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21338 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21339 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21340 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21342 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21343 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21344 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21346 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21348 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21349 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21351 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21352 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21356 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21357 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21358 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21359 authenticated as a client.
21362 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21363 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21364 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21365 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21368 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21369 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21370 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21371 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21372 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21373 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21374 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21377 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21378 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21379 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21380 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21381 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21382 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21383 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21387 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21388 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21389 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21390 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21393 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21394 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21395 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21398 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21399 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21400 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21401 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21402 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21403 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21405 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21406 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21407 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21408 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21409 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21410 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21411 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21412 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21416 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21417 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21418 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21419 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21420 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21423 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21424 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21425 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21426 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21431 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21432 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21433 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21434 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21435 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21436 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21437 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21438 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21440 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21441 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21442 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21443 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21444 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21445 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21447 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21448 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21449 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21450 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21451 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21453 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21454 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21455 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21456 copy of the message is sent.
21458 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21459 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21460 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21461 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21465 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21466 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21467 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21470 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21471 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21472 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21473 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21474 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21475 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21477 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
21478 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21479 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21481 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
21482 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21483 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21485 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
21486 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21487 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21489 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21490 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21491 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21492 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21493 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21494 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21495 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21500 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21501 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21502 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21503 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21504 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21505 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21506 interface address, you could use this:
21508 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21509 {$primary_hostname}}
21511 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21514 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21515 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21516 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21517 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21518 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21519 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21521 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21522 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21523 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21524 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21526 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21527 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21528 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21529 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21530 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21531 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21532 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21534 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21535 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21536 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21537 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21538 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21539 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21540 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21543 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21544 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21547 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21548 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21549 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21550 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21551 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21552 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21553 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21554 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21555 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21556 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21559 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21560 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21561 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21562 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21565 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21566 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21567 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21568 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21571 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21572 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21573 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21574 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21575 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21576 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21577 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21578 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21581 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21582 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21583 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21588 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21589 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21590 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21591 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21592 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21593 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21594 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21595 explanation of when this might be needed.
21598 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21599 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21600 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21601 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21602 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21605 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21606 .cindex "randomized host list"
21607 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21608 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21609 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21610 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21611 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21612 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21613 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21614 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21616 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21617 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21618 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21619 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21621 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21623 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21624 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21625 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21627 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21628 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21629 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21630 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21631 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21632 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21633 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21634 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21635 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21638 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21639 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21640 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21641 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21642 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21643 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21645 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21646 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21647 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21648 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21649 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21650 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21651 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21653 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21654 .cindex "bind IP address"
21655 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21657 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21658 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21659 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21660 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21661 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21662 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21663 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21664 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21667 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21668 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21669 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21670 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21671 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21672 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21674 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21676 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21677 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21678 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21679 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21682 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21683 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21684 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21685 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21686 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21687 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21688 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21689 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21690 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21691 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21695 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21696 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21697 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21698 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21699 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21701 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21702 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21703 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21704 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21705 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21709 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21710 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21711 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21712 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21713 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21714 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21715 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21716 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21719 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21720 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21721 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21722 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21723 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21724 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21725 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21726 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21728 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21729 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21730 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21731 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21736 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21737 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21738 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21739 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21740 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21741 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21742 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21745 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21746 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21747 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21748 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21749 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21750 addresses is not affected.
21752 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21753 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21754 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21755 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21756 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21760 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21761 .cindex "serializing connections"
21762 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21763 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21764 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21765 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21766 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21767 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21768 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21770 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21771 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21772 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21773 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21774 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21775 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21777 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21778 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21779 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21780 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21781 are used for ETRN serialization.
21784 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21785 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21786 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21787 .cindex "size" "of message"
21788 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21789 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21790 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21791 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21792 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21793 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21794 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21795 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21797 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21798 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21801 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21802 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21803 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21805 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21806 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21807 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21808 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21809 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21812 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21813 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21814 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21815 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21819 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21820 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21821 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21822 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21823 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21826 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21827 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21829 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21830 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21831 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21832 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21833 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21834 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21835 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21836 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21839 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21840 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21841 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21843 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21844 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21845 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21846 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21847 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21848 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21849 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21850 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21851 ciphers is a preference order.
21855 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21856 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21857 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21858 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21859 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21860 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21861 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21862 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21863 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21864 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21868 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21869 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21870 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21872 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21873 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21874 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21875 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21876 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21877 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21878 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21879 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21880 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21885 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21887 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21888 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21889 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21890 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21891 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21894 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21895 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21896 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21897 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21900 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21901 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21902 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21904 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21905 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21906 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21907 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21908 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21910 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21911 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21912 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21913 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21914 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21915 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21916 see below for an exception).
21918 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21919 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21920 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21921 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21922 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21924 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21925 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21926 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21927 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21928 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21929 reached their retry times.
21931 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21932 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21933 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21934 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21935 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21936 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21937 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21938 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21939 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21940 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
21943 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
21944 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
21945 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
21946 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
21947 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
21948 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
21950 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
21951 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
21952 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
21953 possible IP addresses have been tried.
21954 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
21955 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
21961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21964 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
21965 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
21966 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
21967 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
21968 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
21969 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
21971 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
21972 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
21973 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
21974 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
21975 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
21976 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
21977 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
21979 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
21980 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
21981 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
21982 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
21985 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
21986 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
21987 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
21988 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
21990 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
21991 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
21992 facility; you do not have to use it.
21994 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
21995 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
21996 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
21997 address to which it applies.
21999 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22000 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22001 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22002 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22003 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22004 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22007 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22008 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22009 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22010 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22013 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22014 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22015 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22016 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22017 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22020 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22021 illustrated by these examples:
22024 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22025 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22026 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22027 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22029 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22030 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22035 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22036 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22037 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22038 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22039 message's processing.
22041 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22042 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22043 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22044 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22045 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22046 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22047 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22048 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22049 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22051 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22052 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22053 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22054 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22055 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22056 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22057 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22058 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22059 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22060 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22062 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22063 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22064 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22065 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22066 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22067 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22069 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22070 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22071 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22073 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22074 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22075 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22076 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22077 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22078 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22079 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22080 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22081 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22083 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22084 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22090 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22091 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22092 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22093 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22094 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22095 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22096 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22097 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22098 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22099 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22101 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22103 might produce the output
22105 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22106 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22107 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22108 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22109 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22110 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22111 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22112 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22114 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22115 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22116 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22117 set for a particular transport.
22120 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22121 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22122 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22125 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22127 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22128 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22129 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22130 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22132 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22133 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22134 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22135 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22138 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22139 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22140 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22142 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22143 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22144 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22145 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22146 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22147 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22148 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22150 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22151 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22152 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22153 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22154 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22158 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22159 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22162 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22163 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22164 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22165 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22166 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22167 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22168 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22169 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22170 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22172 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22173 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22174 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22176 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22177 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22178 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22179 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22180 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22181 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22182 of pattern they are set as follows:
22185 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22186 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22187 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22190 *queen@*.fict.example
22192 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22194 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22198 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22199 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22202 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22203 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22204 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22205 rewriting rule of the form
22207 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22209 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22215 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22216 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22217 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22218 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22219 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22223 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22224 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22225 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22226 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22227 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22229 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22231 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22234 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22235 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22236 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22237 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22238 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22239 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22240 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22241 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22242 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22243 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22244 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22245 entry written to the panic log.
22249 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22250 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22253 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22256 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22258 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22261 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22262 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22266 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22268 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22269 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22270 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22271 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22272 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22273 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22275 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22276 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22277 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22278 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22279 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22280 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22281 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22282 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22283 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22284 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22286 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22287 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22288 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22290 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22291 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22294 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22295 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22296 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22297 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22298 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22299 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22300 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22301 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22302 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22304 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22305 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22306 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22307 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22308 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22309 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22310 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22311 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22314 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22315 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22316 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22317 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22320 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22321 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22322 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22324 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22325 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22326 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22327 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22329 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22330 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22331 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22333 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22334 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22335 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22336 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22338 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22342 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22345 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22346 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22347 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22348 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22349 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22350 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22351 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22352 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22354 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22355 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22359 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22360 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22362 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22363 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22364 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22366 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22367 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22368 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22369 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22370 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22371 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22372 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22373 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22375 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22376 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22378 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22380 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22381 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22383 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22384 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22385 messages that originate outside the local host:
22387 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22388 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22390 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22393 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22394 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22395 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22396 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22397 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22398 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22399 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22400 components. For example, the rule
22402 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22404 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22405 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22406 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22407 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22408 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22409 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22410 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22420 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22421 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22422 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22423 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22424 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22425 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22426 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22427 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22428 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22429 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22430 address, domain and error.
22432 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22433 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22434 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22435 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22436 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22437 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22438 log selector is set, the message
22439 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22440 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22441 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22442 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22444 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22445 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22446 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22447 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22448 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22449 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22450 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22451 domain are maintained independently.
22453 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22454 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22455 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22456 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22457 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22458 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22459 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22460 the local address is reached.
22462 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22463 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22464 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22465 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22466 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22468 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22469 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22470 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22471 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22472 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22473 messages that it should now be retaining.
22477 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22478 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22479 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22480 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22481 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22482 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22483 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22484 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22485 message's sender, respectively.
22488 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22489 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22490 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22491 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22492 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22493 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22496 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22498 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22501 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22503 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22504 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22507 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22508 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22509 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22510 expressions work in address lists.
22512 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22513 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22517 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22518 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22519 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22520 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22521 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22522 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22523 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22524 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22525 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22527 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22528 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22529 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22530 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22533 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22534 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22535 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22536 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22537 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22538 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22539 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22540 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22541 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22542 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22547 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22549 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22550 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22551 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22552 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22553 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22554 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22556 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22560 and the retry rules are
22562 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22563 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22565 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22566 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22567 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22568 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22569 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22570 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22572 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22573 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22574 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22575 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22577 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22578 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22579 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22581 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22583 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22584 textual form of the IP address.
22586 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22587 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22588 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22589 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22592 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22593 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22594 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22596 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22597 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22598 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22600 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22601 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22603 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22604 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22607 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22608 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22609 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22610 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22611 retry rule of this form:
22613 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22615 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22616 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22619 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22620 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22621 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22622 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22624 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22625 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22627 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22628 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22631 A connection was refused.
22633 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22634 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22636 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22637 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22639 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22640 A connection attempt timed out.
22642 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22643 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22644 obtained from an MX record.
22646 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22647 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22648 obtained from an MX record.
22651 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22653 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22654 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22655 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22656 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22659 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22662 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22663 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22664 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22665 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22666 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22667 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22671 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22672 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22673 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22674 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22675 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22679 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22680 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22681 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22683 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22684 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22685 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22686 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22687 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22688 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22689 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22691 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22692 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22695 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22696 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22697 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22702 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22703 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22704 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22705 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22706 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22709 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22711 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22713 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22715 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22716 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22719 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22721 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22722 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22723 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22724 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22725 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22727 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22728 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22730 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22732 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22733 list is never matched.
22739 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22740 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22741 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22742 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22744 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22746 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22747 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22748 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22749 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22750 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22752 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22753 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22754 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22755 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22756 The available algorithms are:
22759 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22762 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22763 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22764 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22766 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22767 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22768 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22769 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22770 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22771 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22772 queue processing times.
22775 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22776 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22777 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22778 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22779 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22780 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22781 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22782 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22783 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22784 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22785 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22786 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22788 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22789 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22790 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22791 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22792 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22793 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22796 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22797 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22798 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22799 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22800 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22801 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22802 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22803 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22804 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22805 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22806 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22807 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22809 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22810 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22811 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22812 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22813 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22814 deliveries that have been deferred.
22817 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22818 Here are some example retry rules:
22820 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22821 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22822 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22823 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22824 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22825 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22827 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22828 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22829 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22830 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22831 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22832 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22833 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22836 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22837 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22838 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22839 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22840 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22842 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22843 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22844 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22845 were not obtained from an MX record.
22847 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22848 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22849 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22850 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22851 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22855 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22856 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22857 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22858 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22859 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22860 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22861 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22862 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22863 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22864 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22865 failing for the first time.
22867 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22868 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22869 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22870 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22872 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22873 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22874 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22879 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22880 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22881 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22882 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22883 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22884 default retry rule:
22886 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22888 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22889 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22890 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22892 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22893 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22894 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22895 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22896 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22898 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22899 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22900 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22902 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22903 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22904 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22905 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22906 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22907 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22908 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22909 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22911 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22912 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22913 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22914 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22915 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22918 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22919 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22920 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22921 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22922 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22923 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22924 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22925 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22926 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22929 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22930 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22931 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22932 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22933 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22934 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22935 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22936 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22939 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22940 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22941 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22942 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
22943 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
22944 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
22945 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
22946 time out the address.
22948 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
22949 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
22950 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
22951 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
22952 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
22953 considered immediately.
22954 .ecindex IIDretconf1
22955 .ecindex IIDregconf2
22962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22965 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
22966 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
22967 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
22968 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
22969 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22970 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22971 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
22972 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
22973 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
22976 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
22977 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
22980 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
22981 the client's EHLO command.
22983 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
22984 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
22986 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
22987 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
22988 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
22989 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
22990 with the AUTH command.
22992 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
22994 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
22995 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
22996 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22999 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23000 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23001 unauthenticated connection.
23004 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23005 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23006 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23007 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23009 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23010 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23011 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23012 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23013 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23014 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23015 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23016 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23021 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23022 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23023 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23024 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23025 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23026 included by setting
23029 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23033 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23034 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23035 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23036 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23037 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23038 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23040 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23041 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23042 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23043 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23044 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23045 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23046 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23048 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23049 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23050 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23051 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23052 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23053 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23057 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23058 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23060 client_secret = secret2
23062 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23063 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23065 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23066 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23067 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23072 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23073 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23074 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23076 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23077 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23078 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23079 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23080 encrypted by a setting such as:
23082 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23084 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23085 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23086 cipher used for the delivery.)
23089 .option driver authenticators string unset
23090 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23091 authenticators is to be used.
23094 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23095 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23096 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23097 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23098 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23099 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23102 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23103 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23104 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23105 mechanism is not advertised.
23106 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23107 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23108 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23111 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23112 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23113 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23116 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23117 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23118 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23119 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23120 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23121 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23122 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23123 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23124 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23128 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23129 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23130 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23131 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23132 out the values of variables.
23133 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23134 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23137 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23138 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23139 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23140 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23141 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23142 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23143 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23144 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23145 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23148 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23149 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23150 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23151 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23152 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23153 remembered for later use.
23154 How it is used is described in the following section.
23160 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23161 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23162 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23163 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23164 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23168 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23169 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23171 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23173 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23174 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23175 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23176 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23177 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23178 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23179 given for the MAIL command.
23181 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23182 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23185 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23186 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23187 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23188 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23189 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23190 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23191 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23196 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23197 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23198 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23199 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23201 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23202 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23203 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23204 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23205 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23210 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23211 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23212 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23213 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23217 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23219 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23220 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23223 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23224 the mechanisms are advertised.
23226 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23227 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23228 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23229 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23230 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23231 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23232 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23234 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23236 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23238 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23239 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23240 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23243 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23245 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23246 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23247 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23249 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23250 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23251 command. This is the case if
23254 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23256 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23258 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23259 server authenticators.
23263 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23264 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23265 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23267 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23268 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23269 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23270 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23271 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23272 rejected with a 504 error.
23274 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23275 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23276 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23277 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23278 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23279 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23280 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23281 no successful authentication.
23286 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23287 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23288 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23289 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23290 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23291 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23292 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23296 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23298 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23299 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23300 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23301 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23302 command line to run this script on such data might be
23304 encode '\0user\0password'
23306 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23307 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23308 whose code value is zero.
23310 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23311 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23312 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23313 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23315 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23316 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23317 example, a command such as
23319 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23321 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23323 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23324 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23326 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23328 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23329 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23330 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23331 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23335 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23336 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23337 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23338 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23339 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23340 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23343 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23344 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23345 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23346 of the authenticator.
23349 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23350 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23351 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23352 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23353 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23354 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23355 delivery to be deferred.
23357 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23358 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23359 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23362 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23363 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23364 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23365 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23366 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23367 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23368 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23369 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23370 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23373 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23374 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23375 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23376 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23377 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23378 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23379 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23380 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23381 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23382 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23383 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23384 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23385 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23395 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23396 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23397 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23398 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23399 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23400 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23401 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23402 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23403 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23404 connections as you do for login accounts.
23406 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23407 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23408 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23410 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23411 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23412 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23414 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23415 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23416 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23419 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23420 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23421 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23422 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23423 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23424 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23425 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23427 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23428 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23429 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23430 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23431 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23432 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23433 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23435 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23436 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23437 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23438 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23440 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23441 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23442 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23444 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23445 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23446 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23447 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23448 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23449 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23450 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23451 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23452 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23453 string as the error text.
23455 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23456 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23457 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23461 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23462 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23463 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23464 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23465 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23466 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23467 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23468 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23470 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23471 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23472 configured as follows:
23476 public_name = PLAIN
23478 server_condition = \
23479 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23480 server_set_id = $auth2
23482 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23483 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23484 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23485 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23487 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23488 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23489 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23490 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23494 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23496 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23498 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23499 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23503 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23504 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23506 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23507 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23508 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23509 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23510 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23512 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23513 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23514 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23516 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23517 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23518 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23519 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23520 This is an incorrect example:
23522 server_condition = \
23523 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23525 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23526 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23527 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23528 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23529 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23530 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23531 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23533 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23534 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23536 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23537 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23538 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23539 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23540 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23543 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23544 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23545 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23546 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23547 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23548 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23549 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23553 public_name = LOGIN
23554 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23555 server_condition = \
23556 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23557 server_set_id = $auth1
23559 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23560 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23561 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23562 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23564 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23565 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23566 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23567 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23568 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23572 public_name = LOGIN
23573 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23574 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
23575 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23576 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23577 ldap://ldap.example.org/}}
23578 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23580 Note the use of the &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator to correctly quote the DN for
23581 authentication. However, the basic &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the
23582 LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
23583 quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
23584 LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
23588 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23589 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23590 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23591 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23592 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23598 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23599 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23600 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23602 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23603 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23604 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23605 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23608 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23609 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23610 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23611 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23612 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23613 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23614 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23615 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23616 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23617 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23618 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23619 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23621 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23622 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23624 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23625 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23626 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23627 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23630 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23631 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23635 public_name = PLAIN
23636 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23638 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23639 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23640 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23644 public_name = LOGIN
23645 client_send = : username : mysecret
23647 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23648 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23650 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23651 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23659 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23660 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23661 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23662 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23663 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23664 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23665 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23666 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23667 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23668 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23669 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23670 available in plain text at either end.
23673 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23674 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23675 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23676 authenticator as a server:
23678 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23679 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23680 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23681 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23682 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23683 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23684 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23685 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23686 returned to the client.
23688 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23689 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23690 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23691 numeric variables for other things.
23693 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23694 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23695 user name, authentication fails.
23699 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23700 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23701 server_set_id = $auth1
23703 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23704 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23705 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23706 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23710 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23711 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23713 server_set_id = $auth1
23715 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23716 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23719 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23720 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23721 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23725 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23726 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23727 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23730 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23731 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23732 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23736 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23737 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23738 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23739 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23740 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23741 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23742 send the message to the current server.
23744 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23749 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23751 client_secret = secret
23753 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23754 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23761 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23762 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23763 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23764 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23766 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23767 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23769 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23770 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23771 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23772 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23773 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23775 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23776 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23777 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23778 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23780 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23781 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23782 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23783 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23784 depending on the driver you are using.
23786 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23787 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23788 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23789 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23790 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23791 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23792 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23793 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23794 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23797 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23798 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23799 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23800 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23801 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23802 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23806 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23807 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23808 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23809 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23812 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23813 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23814 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23815 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23819 driver = cyrus_sasl
23820 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23821 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23822 server_set_id = $auth1
23825 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23826 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23829 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23830 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23833 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23834 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23835 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23836 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23839 driver = cyrus_sasl
23840 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23841 server_set_id = $auth1
23844 driver = cyrus_sasl
23845 public_name = PLAIN
23846 server_set_id = $auth1
23848 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23849 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23850 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23851 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23852 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23859 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23860 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23861 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23862 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23863 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23864 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23865 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23866 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23868 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23870 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23871 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23872 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23873 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23877 public_name = PLAIN
23878 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23879 server_set_id = $auth1
23884 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23885 server_set_id = $auth1
23887 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23888 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23889 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23890 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23891 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23892 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23893 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23894 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23900 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23901 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23902 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23903 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23904 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23905 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23906 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23907 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23908 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23909 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23910 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23911 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23912 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23916 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23917 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23919 The server sends back a challenge.
23921 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23922 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23925 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23929 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23930 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23931 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23933 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23934 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23935 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23936 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23937 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23938 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23939 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23940 for other things. For example:
23945 server_password = \
23946 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
23948 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23949 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23955 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
23956 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
23957 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
23961 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
23962 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23965 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
23966 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23969 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
23970 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
23971 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
23977 client_username = msn/msn_username
23978 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
23979 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
23981 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
23982 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
23988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23991 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
23992 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
23993 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
23994 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
23995 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
23998 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
23999 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24000 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24001 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24002 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24003 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24004 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24005 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24006 certificates are used.
24008 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24009 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24010 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24011 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24012 between them is encrypted.
24014 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24015 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24016 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24017 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24020 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24021 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24022 in order to get TLS to work.
24026 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24028 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24029 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24030 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24031 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24032 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24033 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24034 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24035 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24036 allocated for this purpose.
24038 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24039 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24040 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24041 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24043 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24045 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24046 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24047 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24048 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24049 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24052 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24053 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24060 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24061 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24062 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24063 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24064 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24068 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24072 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24073 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24075 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24078 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24079 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24081 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24082 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24083 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24085 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24086 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24087 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24088 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24090 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24091 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24092 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24093 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24094 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24095 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24098 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24099 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24103 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24104 GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24105 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24106 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24107 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24108 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the RSA and D-H
24109 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24110 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24111 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24112 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24113 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24115 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24116 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24117 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24118 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24119 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24120 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24121 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24122 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24124 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24125 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24126 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24128 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24129 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24130 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24131 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24135 # chown exim:exim new-params
24136 # chmod 0400 new-params
24137 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24138 # echo "" >>new-params
24139 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24140 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24142 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24143 stalling is removed.
24146 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24147 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24148 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24149 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24150 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24151 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24152 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24153 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24154 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24157 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24159 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24160 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24161 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24164 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24165 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24166 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24170 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24173 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24174 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24177 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24178 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24180 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24181 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24184 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24185 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24186 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24187 not be moved to the end of the list.
24192 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24194 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24195 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24196 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24197 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24198 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24199 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24200 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24201 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24202 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24203 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24204 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24205 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24206 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24207 passed to its control function.
24209 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24210 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24211 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24212 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24213 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24214 the same as if just AES were given.
24216 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24217 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24218 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24219 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24220 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24221 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24222 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24224 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24225 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24226 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24227 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24228 can be changed in the usual way.
24230 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24231 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24232 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24233 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24234 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24236 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24237 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24238 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24239 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24241 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24243 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24245 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24247 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24249 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24250 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24251 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24252 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24254 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24255 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24256 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24258 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24259 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24261 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24262 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24264 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24265 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24266 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24267 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24268 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24273 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24274 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24275 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24276 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24277 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24278 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24279 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24280 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24282 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24283 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24284 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24287 554 Security failure
24289 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24290 rejected with a 554 error code.
24292 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24293 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24294 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24295 without some further configuration at the server end.
24297 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24298 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24300 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24301 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24303 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24304 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24305 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24306 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24307 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24308 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24309 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24310 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24311 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24312 the server's certificate.
24314 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24315 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24316 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24318 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24319 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24320 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24323 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24324 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24325 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24327 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24329 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24330 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24331 suites that the server supports. See the command
24335 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24336 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24338 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24339 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24340 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24341 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24342 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24344 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24345 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24346 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24347 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24348 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24349 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24350 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24351 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24352 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24353 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24356 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24357 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24358 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24359 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24360 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24361 documentation for more details.
24364 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24365 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24366 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24367 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24368 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24369 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24370 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24371 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24372 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24373 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24374 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24375 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24377 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24380 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24381 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24382 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24384 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24386 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24388 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24389 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24390 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24391 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24392 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24393 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24394 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24395 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24396 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24397 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24399 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24400 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24401 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24402 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24404 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24405 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24406 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24407 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24408 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24409 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24412 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24413 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24414 .cindex "revocation list"
24415 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24416 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24417 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24418 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24419 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24420 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24424 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24425 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24426 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24427 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24428 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24429 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24430 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24431 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24432 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24434 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24435 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24436 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24437 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24438 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24440 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24441 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24442 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24443 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24444 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24447 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24448 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24449 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24450 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24451 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24452 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24453 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24454 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24455 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24456 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24459 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24460 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24461 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24462 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
24463 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24464 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24465 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24468 If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
24469 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24470 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24471 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24472 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24475 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24476 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24477 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24478 alternative hosts, if any.
24481 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24482 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24483 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24484 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24485 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24487 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24488 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24489 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24490 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24491 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24492 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24493 outgoing connection.
24497 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24499 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24500 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24501 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24502 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24503 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24504 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24505 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24506 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24507 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24508 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24509 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24511 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24512 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24513 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24514 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24515 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24516 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24517 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24518 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24519 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24521 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24522 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24523 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24524 information is recorded.
24526 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24527 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24528 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24533 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24534 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24535 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24536 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24537 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24538 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24539 to Apache, currently at
24541 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24543 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24544 links to further files.
24545 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24546 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24547 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24549 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24553 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24554 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24555 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24556 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24557 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24558 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24559 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24560 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24561 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24562 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24563 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24564 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24565 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24568 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24569 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24570 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24571 with OpenSSL, like this:
24573 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24576 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24577 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24578 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24579 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24580 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24581 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24582 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24584 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24585 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24586 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24588 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24589 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24590 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24591 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24592 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24593 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24595 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24596 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24597 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24598 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24599 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24600 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24607 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24608 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24609 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24610 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24611 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24612 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24613 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24614 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24615 one very small ACL:
24619 accept hosts = one.host.only
24621 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24622 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24624 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24625 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24626 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24627 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24628 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24629 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24630 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24631 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24634 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24635 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24636 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24637 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24638 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24642 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24643 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24644 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24645 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24646 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24647 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24648 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24649 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24650 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24651 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24652 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24653 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24654 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24655 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24656 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24657 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24658 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24659 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24662 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24663 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24664 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24665 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24666 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24667 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24668 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24669 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24670 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24671 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24672 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24673 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24674 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24675 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24676 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24677 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24678 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24679 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24682 For example, if you set
24684 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24686 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24687 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24688 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24689 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24690 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24691 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24692 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24695 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24696 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24697 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24698 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24699 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24700 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24701 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24702 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24703 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24704 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24705 in any of these ACLs.
24707 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24708 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24709 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24710 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24711 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24712 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24713 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24714 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24716 control = suppress_local_fixups
24718 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24719 run, it is too late.
24721 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24722 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24724 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24725 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24726 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24729 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24730 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24731 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24732 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24733 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24734 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24735 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24736 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24737 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24740 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24741 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24742 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24743 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24744 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24745 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24746 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24747 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24748 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24750 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24751 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24752 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24753 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24757 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24758 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24759 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24760 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24761 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24762 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24763 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24764 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24765 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24766 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24768 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24769 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24770 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24771 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24772 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24773 associated with the DATA command.
24775 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24776 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24777 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24778 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24779 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24783 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24784 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24785 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24788 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24789 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24790 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24791 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24792 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24793 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24795 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24796 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24797 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24798 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24800 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24801 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24803 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24804 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24807 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24808 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24809 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24810 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24811 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24815 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24816 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%smtp_notquit_acl%&, is run in most cases when
24817 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24818 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24819 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24820 situation even worse.
24822 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24823 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24824 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24827 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24828 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24829 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24830 connection. The possible values are:
24832 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24833 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24834 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24835 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24836 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24837 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24838 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24839 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24840 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24841 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24843 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24844 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24845 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24846 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24847 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24851 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24852 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24853 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24854 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24856 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24857 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24859 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24860 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24861 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24862 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24863 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24865 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24866 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24867 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24870 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24871 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24872 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24873 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24874 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24875 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24877 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24878 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24879 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24881 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24882 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24883 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24884 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24886 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24887 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24888 matches the string.
24890 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24891 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24892 want to have something like
24894 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24896 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24897 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24903 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24904 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24905 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24906 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24907 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24908 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24909 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24910 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24911 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24913 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24914 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24915 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24918 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24919 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24920 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24921 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24923 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24924 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24925 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24926 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24927 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24928 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24929 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24932 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24933 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24934 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24938 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
24939 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
24940 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
24941 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24942 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
24943 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
24945 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
24946 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
24947 used to accept or reject anything.
24949 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
24950 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
24951 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
24952 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
24954 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
24955 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
24956 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
24957 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24958 configuration file.
24963 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
24964 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
24966 .vindex &$local_part$&
24967 .vindex &$sender_address$&
24968 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
24969 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24970 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
24971 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
24972 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
24973 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
24974 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
24975 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24977 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
24978 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
24979 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
24982 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24983 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
24984 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
24985 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
24986 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
24989 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
24990 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
24991 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
24992 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
24993 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
24994 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
24995 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
24996 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25002 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25003 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25004 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25005 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25006 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25007 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25008 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25009 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25010 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25011 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25012 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25013 unencrypted connections.
25016 accept encrypted = *
25017 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25019 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25021 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25022 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25023 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25024 option to do this.)
25028 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25029 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25030 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25031 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25032 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25033 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25034 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25036 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25037 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25038 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25041 deny dnslists = list1.example
25042 dnslists = list2.example
25044 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25045 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25046 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25047 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25048 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25051 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25052 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25055 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25056 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25057 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25058 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25059 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25060 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25061 check a RCPT command:
25063 accept domains = +local_domains
25067 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25068 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25069 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25070 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25073 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25074 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25075 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25078 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25079 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25080 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25081 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25082 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25083 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25085 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25086 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25088 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25089 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25090 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25092 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25093 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25094 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25099 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25100 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25101 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25102 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25103 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25104 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25105 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25109 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25110 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25111 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25114 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25116 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25120 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25121 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25122 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25123 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25124 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25125 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25126 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25127 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25128 do not appear in the log line when the &%log_recipients%& log selector is set.
25130 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25131 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25132 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25136 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25137 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25138 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25140 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25141 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25143 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25144 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25147 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25148 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25149 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25150 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25152 require message = Sender did not verify
25155 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25156 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25157 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25158 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25161 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25162 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25163 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25164 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25165 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25166 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25167 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25169 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25170 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25171 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25172 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25173 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25175 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25176 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25177 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25178 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25179 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25180 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25184 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25185 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25186 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25187 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25189 warn !verify = sender
25190 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25194 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25196 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25197 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25198 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25199 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25200 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25204 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25205 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25206 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25207 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25208 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25209 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25210 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25211 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25212 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25213 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25215 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25216 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25217 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25218 on the same SMTP connection.
25220 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25221 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25222 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25225 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25226 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25227 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25229 accept hosts = whatever
25230 set acl_m4 = some value
25231 accept authenticated = *
25232 set acl_c_auth = yes
25234 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25235 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25236 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25238 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25239 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25240 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25241 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25242 error is generated.
25244 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25245 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25248 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25249 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25250 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25251 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25253 deny domains = *.dom.example
25254 !verify = recipient
25256 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25257 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25258 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25259 two statements are equivalent:
25261 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25262 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25264 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25265 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25267 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25268 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25269 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25271 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25272 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25273 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25274 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25276 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25277 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25278 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25279 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25280 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25281 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25282 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25284 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25285 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25286 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25287 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25288 message is handled.
25290 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25291 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25292 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25293 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25295 require message = Can't verify sender
25297 message = Can't verify recipient
25299 message = This message cannot be used
25301 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25302 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25303 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25304 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25305 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25306 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25308 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25309 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25310 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25311 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25314 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25315 message = Invalid sender from client host
25317 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25318 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25322 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25323 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25324 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25327 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25328 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25329 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25330 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25332 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25333 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25334 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25335 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25336 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25337 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25338 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25339 write rather ugly lines like this:
25341 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25343 Instead, all you need is
25345 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25348 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25349 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25350 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25351 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25352 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25353 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25354 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25355 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25357 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25358 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25359 in several different ways. For example:
25361 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25362 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25363 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25367 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25369 accept ...some conditions
25370 control = queue_only
25372 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25373 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25376 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25378 accept ...some conditions...
25379 control = queue_only
25380 ...some more conditions...
25382 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25383 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25384 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25388 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25389 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25392 warn ...some conditions...
25396 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25397 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25401 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25402 &%require%& verb. For example:
25404 require control = no_multiline_responses
25408 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25409 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25411 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25412 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25413 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25414 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25415 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25416 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25418 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25421 deny ...some conditions...
25424 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25425 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25428 ...some conditions...
25430 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25431 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25433 warn ...some conditions...
25439 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25440 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25441 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25442 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25443 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25444 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25445 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25449 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25450 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25451 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25452 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25453 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25454 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25455 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25458 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25459 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25460 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25461 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25463 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25464 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25466 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25469 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25470 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25472 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25473 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25474 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25477 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25478 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25479 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25480 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25481 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25482 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25485 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25486 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25487 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25490 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25491 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25492 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25493 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25494 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25495 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25497 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25498 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25499 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25500 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25501 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25502 logging rejections.
25505 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25506 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25507 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25508 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25509 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25510 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25511 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25512 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25514 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25515 &` log_reject_target =`&
25517 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25518 permanent and temporary rejections.
25521 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25522 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25523 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25524 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25525 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25526 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25527 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25530 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25531 &` control = freeze`&
25532 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25534 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25535 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25536 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25539 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25540 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25544 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25545 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25546 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25547 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25548 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25549 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25550 &%accept%& for details.)
25552 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25553 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25554 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25555 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25556 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25558 require message = Host not recognized
25561 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25564 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25565 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25566 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25567 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25568 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25569 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25570 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25571 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25572 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25575 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25576 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25577 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25579 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25580 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25582 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25583 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25584 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25587 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25588 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25590 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25591 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25592 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25595 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25596 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25597 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25598 However, the original message is available in the variable
25599 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25600 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25601 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25602 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25604 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25605 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25606 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25607 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25608 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25609 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25613 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25614 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25615 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25616 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25623 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25624 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25625 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25628 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25629 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25630 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25631 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25632 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25633 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25634 not work without it. For example:
25636 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25637 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25639 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25640 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25641 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25642 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25643 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25646 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25647 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25648 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25649 .cindex "case of local parts"
25650 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25651 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25652 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25653 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25654 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25655 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25658 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25659 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25660 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25661 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25662 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25664 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25665 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25668 warn control = caseful_local_part
25669 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25671 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25673 control = caselower_local_part
25675 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25676 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25678 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25679 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25680 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25681 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25682 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25683 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25684 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25685 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25687 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25688 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25689 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25690 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25691 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25692 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25696 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25697 .cindex "fake defer"
25698 .cindex "defer, fake"
25699 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25700 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25701 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25702 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25703 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25705 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25706 .cindex "fake rejection"
25707 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25708 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25709 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25710 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25711 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25712 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25713 the same SMTP connection.
25715 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25716 message is supplied, the following is used:
25718 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25719 550-kept for evaluation.
25720 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25721 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25723 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25725 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25726 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25727 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25728 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25729 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25730 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25733 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25734 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25735 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25736 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25738 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25739 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25740 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25741 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25742 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25743 disables such output flushing.
25745 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25746 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25747 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25748 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25749 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25750 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25752 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25753 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25754 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25755 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25756 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25757 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25758 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25759 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25760 to be useful in production.
25762 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25763 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25764 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25765 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25766 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25768 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25769 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25770 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25771 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25772 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25773 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25776 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25777 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25778 verification failed"&) is sent.
25780 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25784 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25785 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25787 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25788 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25789 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25790 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25791 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25792 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25793 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25795 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25796 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25797 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25798 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25799 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25800 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25801 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25802 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25803 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25804 same SMTP connection.
25806 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25807 .cindex "message" "submission"
25808 .cindex "submission mode"
25809 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25810 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25811 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25812 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25813 necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25814 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25815 late (the message has already been created).
25817 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25818 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25819 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25820 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25821 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25823 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25824 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25825 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25826 complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25827 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25830 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25831 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25833 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25835 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25838 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25839 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25840 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25841 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25844 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25845 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25849 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25850 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25853 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25855 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
25856 &`suppress_local_fixups`&.
25858 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25860 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
25865 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25866 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25867 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25868 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25869 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25870 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25872 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25873 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25874 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25876 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25877 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25878 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25879 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25880 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25883 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25884 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25885 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25886 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25888 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25889 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25890 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25891 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25892 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25893 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25894 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25895 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25896 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25897 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25898 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25900 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25901 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25902 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25903 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25904 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25905 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25906 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25907 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25908 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25910 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25911 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25913 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25914 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25916 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25917 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25919 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25920 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25921 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25922 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25925 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25926 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25927 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25928 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25929 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25930 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25931 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25934 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
25935 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
25936 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
25937 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
25938 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
25940 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
25941 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
25942 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25943 to be a header name first.) For example:
25945 warn add_header = \
25946 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25948 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
25949 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
25950 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
25951 up in reverse order.
25953 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25954 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25955 system filter or in a router or transport.
25960 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
25961 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
25962 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25963 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
25964 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
25965 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25967 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
25968 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
25969 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
25970 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
25971 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
25972 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
25973 The conditions are as follows:
25977 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
25978 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
25979 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
25980 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
25981 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
25982 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
25983 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
25984 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
25985 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
25986 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
25987 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
25989 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
25990 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
25991 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
25992 conditions are tested.
25994 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
25995 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
25996 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
25997 for different local users or different local domains.
25999 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26000 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26001 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26002 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26003 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26004 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26005 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26010 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26011 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26012 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26013 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26014 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26015 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26016 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26017 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26018 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26019 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26020 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26021 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26024 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26025 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26026 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26027 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26028 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26029 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26030 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26031 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26033 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26034 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26035 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26036 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26037 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26039 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26040 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26041 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26042 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26043 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26044 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26045 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26046 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26047 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26048 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26050 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26051 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26052 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26053 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26054 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26055 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26056 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26057 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26058 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26061 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26062 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26065 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26066 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26067 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26068 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26069 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26070 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26071 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26077 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26078 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26079 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26080 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26081 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26082 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26083 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26085 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26087 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26088 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26089 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26091 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26092 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26093 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26094 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26095 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26096 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26098 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26099 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26101 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26102 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26104 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26105 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26106 statement can then check the IP address.
26108 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26109 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26110 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26111 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26113 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26114 message = $host_data
26116 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26118 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26119 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26120 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26121 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26122 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26123 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26124 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26125 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26126 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26127 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26129 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26130 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26131 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26132 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26133 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26134 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26135 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26137 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26138 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26139 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26140 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26141 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26142 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26143 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26146 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26147 .cindex "rate limiting"
26148 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26149 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26151 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26152 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26153 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26154 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26155 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26156 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26158 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26159 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26160 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26161 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26162 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26163 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26164 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26166 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26167 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26168 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26169 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26170 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26171 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26172 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26173 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26174 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26175 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26176 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26177 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26178 influence the sender checking.
26180 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26181 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26183 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26184 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26185 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26186 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26187 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26188 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26192 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26193 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26195 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26196 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26197 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26198 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26199 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26200 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26202 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26203 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26204 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26205 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26206 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26207 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26208 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26209 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26210 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26211 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26213 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26214 .cindex "CSA verification"
26215 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26216 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26217 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26219 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26220 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26221 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26222 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26223 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26224 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26225 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26226 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26227 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26228 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26229 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26230 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26231 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26232 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26233 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26235 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26236 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26237 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26238 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26241 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26242 !verify = header_sender
26245 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26246 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26247 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26248 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26249 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26250 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26251 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26252 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26253 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26254 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26255 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26256 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26259 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26260 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26264 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26265 common as they used to be.
26267 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26268 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26269 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26270 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26271 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26272 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26273 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26274 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26275 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26276 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26277 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26278 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26279 independently of this condition.
26281 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26282 option), this condition is always true.
26285 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26286 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26287 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26288 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26289 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26290 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26291 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26292 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26293 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26295 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26296 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26299 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26300 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26301 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26302 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26303 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26304 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26305 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26306 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26307 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26308 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26309 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26310 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26311 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26312 value for the child address.
26314 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26315 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26316 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26317 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26318 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26319 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26320 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26321 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26322 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26323 original IP address.
26325 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26326 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26328 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26329 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26330 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26331 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26332 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26333 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26334 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26335 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26336 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26338 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26339 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26340 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26341 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26342 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26343 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26344 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26346 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26347 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26348 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26350 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26351 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26352 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26353 verified as a sender.
26358 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26359 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26360 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26361 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26362 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26363 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26364 address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
26365 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26367 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26368 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26370 the following records are looked up:
26372 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26373 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26375 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26376 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26377 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26378 use two separate conditions:
26380 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26381 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26383 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26384 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26385 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26388 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26389 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26390 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26391 following special items in the list:
26393 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26394 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26395 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26397 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26398 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26399 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26400 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26402 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26404 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26405 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26407 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26408 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26409 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26411 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26412 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26413 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26414 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26418 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26419 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26420 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26421 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26422 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26424 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26426 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26427 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26428 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26429 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26434 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26435 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26436 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26437 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26438 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26439 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26440 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26442 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26443 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26445 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26446 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26447 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26448 up by this example is
26450 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26452 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26453 addresses. For example:
26455 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26456 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26458 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26459 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26464 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26465 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26466 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26467 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26468 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26469 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26470 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26471 either to double the separators like this:
26473 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26475 or to change the separator character, like this:
26477 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26479 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26480 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26481 occurs. Consider this condition:
26483 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26485 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26487 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26488 a.domain.black.list.tld
26490 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26491 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26492 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26493 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26494 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26495 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26496 error for a previous item.
26498 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26499 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26501 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26502 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26504 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26505 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26507 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26508 $sender_address_domain \
26509 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26511 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26512 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26513 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26515 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26516 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26517 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26518 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26520 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26522 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26523 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26525 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26526 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26531 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26532 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26533 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26534 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26535 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26536 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26540 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26542 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26543 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26544 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26546 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26547 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26548 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26551 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26552 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26553 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26554 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26555 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26556 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26557 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26558 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26559 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26560 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26561 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26562 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26563 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26564 cases, for example:
26566 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26568 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26569 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26570 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26571 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26573 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26575 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26576 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26578 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26579 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26580 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26581 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26582 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26585 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26586 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26587 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26589 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26590 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26592 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26597 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26598 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26599 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26600 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26603 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26605 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26606 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26607 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26608 describes how multiple records are handled.
26610 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26611 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26612 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26614 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26616 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26617 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26618 first. For example:
26620 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26621 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26624 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26625 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26626 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26627 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26628 tested. For example:
26630 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26632 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26633 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26634 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26636 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26638 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26643 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26644 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26647 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26649 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26650 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26652 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26654 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26655 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26656 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26657 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26659 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26660 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26662 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26663 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26665 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26666 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26668 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26669 Consider this example:
26671 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26673 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26676 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26678 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26680 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26681 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26682 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26684 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26689 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26690 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26691 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26692 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26693 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26694 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26696 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26698 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26699 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26700 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26701 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26702 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26703 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26706 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26707 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26708 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26710 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26711 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26714 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26716 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26717 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26719 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26721 for the condition to be true.
26724 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26725 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26727 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26728 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26730 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26732 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26733 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26735 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26736 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26738 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26740 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26741 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26743 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26745 for the condition to be false.
26747 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26748 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26753 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26754 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26755 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26756 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26757 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26758 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26759 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26760 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26761 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26764 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26765 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26766 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26767 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26768 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26769 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26770 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26773 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26774 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26776 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26777 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26779 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26780 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26781 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26782 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26783 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26784 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26786 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26787 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26788 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26790 reject dnslists = \
26791 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26792 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26793 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26794 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26796 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26797 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26798 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26802 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26803 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26804 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26805 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26806 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26807 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26809 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26810 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26812 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26813 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26814 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26816 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26818 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26819 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26821 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26822 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26824 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26825 dnslists = some.list.example
26828 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26829 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26830 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26831 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26832 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26833 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26834 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26835 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26836 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26837 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26839 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26841 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26842 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26844 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26845 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26846 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26849 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26850 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26851 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26852 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26853 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26854 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26855 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26856 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26857 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26859 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26860 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26861 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26862 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26864 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26865 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
26866 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
26867 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
26868 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26869 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26870 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26871 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26872 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26873 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
26875 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
26876 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
26877 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
26880 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
26881 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26882 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26883 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26884 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26886 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26887 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26888 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26889 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26890 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26891 appear in any order.
26893 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26894 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26896 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26897 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26899 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26900 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26901 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
26902 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
26903 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
26904 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26906 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
26907 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
26908 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
26909 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
26910 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
26911 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
26912 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
26913 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
26916 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26917 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
26918 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
26919 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
26920 rather than recipients, are accepted.
26922 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26923 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26924 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26925 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26926 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26927 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26928 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26930 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
26931 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
26932 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
26933 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26934 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
26935 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
26936 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
26937 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
26938 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
26941 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
26943 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
26944 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
26945 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
26946 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
26947 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
26948 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
26949 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
26951 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
26952 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
26953 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
26954 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
26955 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
26956 message. For example:
26958 # Log all senders' rates
26959 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
26960 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
26962 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
26963 # at the decimal point.
26964 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
26965 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
26966 $sender_rate_limit }s
26968 # Keep authenticated users under control
26969 deny authenticated = *
26970 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
26972 # System-wide rate limit
26973 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
26974 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
26976 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
26977 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
26978 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
26979 messages per $sender_rate_period
26980 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
26981 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
26982 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
26984 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
26985 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
26986 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
26987 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
26988 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
26989 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
26990 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
26993 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
26994 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
26995 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
26996 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
26997 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
26998 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
26999 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27000 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27004 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / noupdate
27005 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27006 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27009 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27013 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27014 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27015 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27016 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27018 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27019 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27020 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27024 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27025 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27026 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27027 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27028 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27029 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27030 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27031 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27032 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27034 verify = sender/callout
27035 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27037 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27038 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27039 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27040 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27041 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27042 The available options are as follows:
27045 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27046 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27047 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27049 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27050 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27051 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27052 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27054 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27055 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27057 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27058 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27059 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27060 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27063 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27064 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27065 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27066 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27067 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27068 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27071 warn !verify = sender
27072 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27074 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27075 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27076 verification failure.
27078 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27079 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27082 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27083 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27085 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27087 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27088 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27089 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27091 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27093 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27096 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27097 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27102 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27103 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27104 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27105 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27106 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27107 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27108 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27109 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27110 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27111 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27112 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27113 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27116 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27117 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27118 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27119 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27120 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27121 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27123 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27124 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27125 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27126 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27127 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27129 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27130 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27131 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27132 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27133 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27134 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27135 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27136 supplies a host list.
27138 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27139 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27140 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27141 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27142 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27143 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27144 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27146 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27147 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27148 following SMTP commands are sent:
27150 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27152 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27155 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27158 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27159 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27160 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27161 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27162 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27163 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27165 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27166 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27167 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27168 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27169 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27171 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27172 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27173 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27174 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27175 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27180 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27181 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27182 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27183 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27185 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27187 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27188 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27189 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27193 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27194 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27195 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27198 verify = sender/callout=5s
27200 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27201 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27202 the &%connect%& parameter.
27205 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27206 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27207 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27208 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27210 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27212 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27214 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27215 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27216 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27217 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27218 updated in this circumstance.
27220 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27221 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27222 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27223 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27224 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27225 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27228 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27229 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27230 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27231 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27232 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27233 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27234 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27235 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27236 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27237 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27239 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27241 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27244 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27245 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27246 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27249 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27251 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27252 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27253 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27254 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27255 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27258 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27259 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27260 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27261 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27263 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27264 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27265 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27266 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27267 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27268 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27269 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27270 made, until the cache record expires.
27272 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27273 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27274 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27277 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27279 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27280 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27282 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27284 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27285 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27286 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27287 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27291 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27292 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27293 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27294 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27295 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27297 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27299 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27300 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27301 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27302 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27303 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27305 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27306 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27307 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27309 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27311 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27312 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27313 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27314 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27315 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27317 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27318 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27320 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27322 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27323 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27324 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27325 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27326 usefulness of callout caching.
27329 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27330 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27331 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27332 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27333 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27334 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27335 these circumstances.
27337 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27338 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27339 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27340 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27341 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27342 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27343 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27345 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27346 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27347 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27348 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27353 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27354 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27355 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27356 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27357 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27358 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27359 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27360 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27361 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27362 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27364 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27365 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27368 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27369 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27370 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27372 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27373 commands up to and including
27377 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27378 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27379 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27380 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27381 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27382 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27383 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27385 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27386 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27387 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27388 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27389 will eventually be noticed.
27391 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27392 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27393 behaviour will be the same.
27397 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27398 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27399 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27400 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27401 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27402 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27405 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27407 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27408 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27409 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27410 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27411 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27412 550 Sender verification failed
27414 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27415 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27416 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27417 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27420 verify = sender/no_details
27423 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27424 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27425 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27426 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27427 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27428 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27429 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27432 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27433 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27434 verification also fails.
27436 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27437 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27440 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27441 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27442 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27445 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27447 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27448 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27449 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27450 verification to succeed.
27452 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27453 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27454 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27455 option. For example:
27457 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27459 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27460 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27462 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27463 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27464 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27465 address and a report is output for each of them.
27469 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27470 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27471 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27472 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27473 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27474 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27475 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27479 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27480 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27481 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27482 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27483 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27484 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27486 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27487 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27488 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27489 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27492 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27494 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27496 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27497 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27499 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27500 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27503 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27504 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27506 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27508 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27509 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27510 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27511 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27514 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27516 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27517 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27518 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27520 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27521 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27522 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27523 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27524 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27525 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27526 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27527 of legitimate HELO domains.
27529 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27530 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27531 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27532 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27535 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27537 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27538 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27539 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27544 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27545 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27546 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27547 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27548 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27549 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27550 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27551 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27553 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27554 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27555 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27556 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27557 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27558 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27559 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27561 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27562 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27565 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27566 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27569 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27570 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27573 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27574 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27576 recipients = +batv_senders
27578 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27579 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27581 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27582 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27583 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27585 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27586 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27587 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27588 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27589 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27591 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27592 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27593 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27594 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27595 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27596 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27597 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27599 There are two more issues you must consider when implementing prvs-signing.
27600 Firstly, you need to ensure that prvs-signed addresses are not blocked by your
27601 ACLs. A prvs-signed address contains a slash character, but the default Exim
27602 configuration contains this statement in the RCPT ACL:
27604 deny message = Restricted characters in address
27605 domains = +local_domains
27606 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
27608 This is a conservative rule that blocks local parts that contain slashes. You
27609 should remove the slash in the last line.
27611 Secondly, you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27612 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27613 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27617 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27619 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27620 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27621 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27624 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27627 external_smtp_batv:
27629 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27630 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27631 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27632 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27635 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27639 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27640 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27641 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27642 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27643 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27644 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27645 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27646 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27647 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27648 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27650 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27651 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27652 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27653 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27654 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27655 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27657 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27659 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27660 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27661 system to arbitrary domains.
27664 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27665 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27666 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27667 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27670 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27671 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27672 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27674 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27675 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27677 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27678 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27682 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27684 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27685 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27686 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27688 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27692 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27693 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27695 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27696 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27697 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27698 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27699 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27700 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27701 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27705 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27706 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27707 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27708 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27709 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27711 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27712 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27713 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27714 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27715 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27716 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27717 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27725 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27726 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27727 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27728 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27729 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27730 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27733 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27734 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27735 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27736 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27737 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27739 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27740 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27741 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27744 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27745 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27747 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27748 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27749 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27751 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27752 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27754 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27757 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27760 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27761 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27762 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27764 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27765 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27766 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27767 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27768 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27769 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27771 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27772 temporarily created in a file called:
27774 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27776 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27777 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27778 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27779 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27780 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27782 control = no_mbox_unspool
27784 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27785 same directory by default.
27789 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27790 .cindex "virus scanning"
27791 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27792 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27793 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27794 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27795 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27796 in memory and thus are much faster.
27798 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27799 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27800 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27801 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27803 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27805 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27807 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27809 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27810 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27813 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27814 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27815 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27816 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27817 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27820 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27824 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27825 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27826 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27827 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27828 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27829 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27830 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27832 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27833 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27835 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27836 contributing the code for this scanner.
27839 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27840 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27841 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27842 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27845 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27846 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27849 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27850 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27851 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27852 the &"trigger"& expression.
27855 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27856 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27857 &"name"& expression.
27860 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27862 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27864 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27865 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27866 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27867 configuration setting:
27869 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27870 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27871 found in file:'(.+)'
27874 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27875 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27876 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27877 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27879 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27880 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27882 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27883 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27886 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27887 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27888 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27890 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27892 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27893 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27895 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27896 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27897 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27898 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27899 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27902 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27904 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27907 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27908 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27909 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27910 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27911 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27912 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27913 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27915 av_scanner = mksd:2
27917 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27920 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27921 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27922 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27923 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27924 client communication. For example:
27926 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27928 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27932 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27933 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27936 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
27937 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
27938 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
27939 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
27940 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
27941 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
27944 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
27945 use. It can then be one of
27948 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
27949 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
27952 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
27953 the condition fails immediately.
27955 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
27956 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
27957 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
27960 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
27961 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
27962 causes the ACL to defer.
27964 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
27965 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
27966 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
27967 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
27970 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
27971 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
27972 &%malware%& condition.
27974 Here is a very simple scanning example:
27976 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27980 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
27982 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27984 malware = */defer_ok
27986 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
27987 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
27989 av_scanner = $acl_m0
27991 in the main Exim configuration.
27993 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27994 set acl_m0 = sophie
27997 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27998 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28003 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28004 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28005 .cindex "spam scanning"
28006 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28007 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28008 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28009 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28010 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28012 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28014 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28015 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28018 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28019 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28020 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28021 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28022 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28024 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28026 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28027 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28028 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28031 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28033 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28034 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28035 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28036 option, separated with colons:
28038 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28039 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28042 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28043 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28044 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28047 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28048 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28050 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28051 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28052 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28055 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28056 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28058 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28061 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28062 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28063 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28064 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28065 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28067 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28068 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28069 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28070 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28071 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28074 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28075 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28076 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28079 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28080 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28081 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28084 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28085 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28089 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28090 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28091 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28092 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28094 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28095 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28096 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28097 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28098 used at delivery time.
28101 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28102 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28103 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28105 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28106 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28107 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28108 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28109 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in
28110 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28111 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28112 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28113 transports during the later delivery phase.
28115 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28116 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28117 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28118 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28119 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28121 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28122 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28123 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28126 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28127 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28128 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28130 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28131 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28132 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28133 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28134 spam condition, like this:
28136 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28137 spam = joe/defer_ok
28139 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28141 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28144 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28145 warn spam = nobody:true
28146 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28147 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28149 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28150 # is over threshold
28152 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28154 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28155 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28157 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28162 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28163 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28164 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28165 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28166 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28167 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28168 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28169 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28170 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28171 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28174 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28175 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28176 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28177 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28178 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28179 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28180 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28182 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28183 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28184 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28185 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28186 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28188 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28189 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28190 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28191 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28192 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28195 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28197 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28201 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28203 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28204 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28205 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28206 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28208 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28209 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28210 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28211 the full path and file name.
28213 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28214 filename, and the default path is then used.
28216 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28217 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28218 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28220 decode = $mime_filename
28222 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28223 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28224 automatically unlinked.
28226 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28227 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28228 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28229 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28230 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28232 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28233 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28234 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28236 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28237 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28238 available in the MIME ACL:
28241 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28242 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28243 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28244 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28245 contains the empty string.
28247 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28248 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28249 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28255 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28256 case-insensitively.
28258 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28259 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28260 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28261 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28262 only used for display purposes.
28264 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28265 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28266 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28268 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28269 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28270 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28272 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28273 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28274 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28275 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28276 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28278 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28279 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28280 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28281 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28283 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28284 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28285 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28286 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28290 application/octet-stream
28294 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28297 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28298 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28299 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28300 containing the decoded data.
28305 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28306 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28307 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28308 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28309 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28310 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28312 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28313 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28314 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28315 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28317 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28318 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28322 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28325 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28326 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28329 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28330 and the rest are attachments.
28333 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28336 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28337 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28338 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28340 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28341 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28342 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28343 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28345 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28346 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28347 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28348 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28349 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28351 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28352 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28353 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28354 decoding is fully recursive.
28356 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28357 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28358 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28359 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28360 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28361 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28362 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28367 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28368 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28369 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28370 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28371 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28373 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28374 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28375 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28376 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28377 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28379 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28380 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28381 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28382 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28383 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28384 32K characters are checked.
28386 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28387 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28388 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28389 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28390 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28392 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28393 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28395 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28396 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28397 matching regular expression.
28399 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28405 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28406 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28407 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28408 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28409 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28410 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28411 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28412 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28413 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28414 use the &%demime%& condition.
28416 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28417 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28418 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28419 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28420 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28421 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28423 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28424 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28427 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28428 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28430 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28431 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28432 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28433 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28435 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28436 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28437 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28439 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28442 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28443 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28444 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28445 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28446 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28447 zero, no error occurred.
28449 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28450 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28451 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28452 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28456 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28457 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28458 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28459 extension it found.
28462 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28463 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28465 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28466 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28467 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28470 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28471 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28473 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28475 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28476 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28477 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28478 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28480 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28481 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28482 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28494 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28495 "Local scan function"
28496 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28497 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28498 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28499 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28500 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28502 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28503 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28504 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28505 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28506 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28508 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28509 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28510 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28511 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28513 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28514 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28515 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28516 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28518 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28519 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28520 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28521 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28522 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28523 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28524 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28525 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28526 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28530 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28531 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28532 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28533 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28534 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28535 directory, so you might set
28537 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28539 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28540 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28541 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28542 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28543 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28544 _src/local_scan.c_.
28546 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28547 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28549 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28551 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28556 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28557 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28558 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28560 #include "local_scan.h"
28562 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28563 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28564 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28565 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28566 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28567 strings and pointers to character strings:
28569 #define CS (char *)
28570 #define CCS (const char *)
28571 #define CSS (char **)
28572 #define US (unsigned char *)
28573 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28574 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28576 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28578 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28580 The arguments are as follows:
28583 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28584 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28585 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28587 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28588 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28589 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28590 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28591 case this changes in some future version.
28593 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28594 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28597 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28600 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28601 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28602 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28603 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28604 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28605 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28607 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28608 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28609 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28611 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28612 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28613 queued without immediate delivery.
28615 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28616 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28617 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28618 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28619 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28622 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28623 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28624 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28627 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28628 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28629 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28630 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28631 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28632 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28633 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28635 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28636 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28637 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28640 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28641 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28642 &%-oe%& command line options.
28646 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28647 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28648 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28649 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28650 want to do this, you must have the line
28652 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28654 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28655 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28656 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28659 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28660 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28661 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28662 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28663 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28664 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28666 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28667 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28669 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28670 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28671 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28674 int local_scan_options_count =
28675 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28677 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28678 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28682 my_string = some string of text...
28684 The available types of option data are as follows:
28687 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28688 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28689 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28690 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28691 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28692 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28695 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28696 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28697 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28698 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28701 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28702 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28705 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28706 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28707 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28708 printed with the suffix K or M.
28710 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28711 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28712 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28713 always output in octal.
28715 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28716 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28717 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28719 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28720 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28721 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28724 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28725 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28729 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28730 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28731 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28732 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28733 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28734 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28735 C variables are as follows:
28738 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28739 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28741 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28742 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28744 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28745 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28746 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28747 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28750 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28751 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28752 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28755 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28756 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28760 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28761 selected, you should use code like this:
28763 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28764 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28766 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28767 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28768 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28770 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28771 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28774 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28775 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28777 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28778 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28780 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28781 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28782 &%-bh%& command line option.
28784 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28785 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28786 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28788 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28789 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28790 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28791 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28793 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28794 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28795 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28797 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28798 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28800 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28801 The number of accepted recipients.
28803 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28804 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28805 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28806 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28807 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28808 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28809 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28810 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28811 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28812 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28813 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28814 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28816 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28817 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28819 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28820 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28821 locally-submitted messages.
28823 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28824 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28825 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28827 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28828 The name of the sending host, if known.
28830 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28831 The port on the sending host.
28833 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28834 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28836 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28837 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28839 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28840 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28841 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28845 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28846 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28847 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28848 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28853 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28854 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28856 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28857 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28858 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28859 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28860 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28861 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28862 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28864 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28865 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28868 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28869 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28870 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28875 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28876 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28879 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28880 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28882 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28883 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28884 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28885 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28887 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28888 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28889 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28890 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28891 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28892 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28893 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28894 is NULL for all recipients.
28899 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28900 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28901 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28902 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28906 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28907 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28909 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28910 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28911 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28912 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28914 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28915 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28916 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28917 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28918 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28920 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28922 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28923 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28924 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28925 return value is as follows:
28930 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28936 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
28942 The process timed out.
28946 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
28949 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
28950 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
28951 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
28952 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
28953 forks a subprocess that is running
28955 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
28957 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
28958 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
28959 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
28960 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
28962 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
28963 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
28964 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
28965 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
28968 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
28969 *sender_authentication)*&
28970 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
28973 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
28975 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
28978 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
28979 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
28980 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
28981 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
28982 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
28984 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28985 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28988 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
28989 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
28990 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
28991 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
28992 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
28993 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
28994 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
28995 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
28997 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
28998 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
28999 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29000 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29001 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29002 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29004 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29005 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29006 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29007 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29009 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29010 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29011 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29012 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29013 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29014 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29015 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29016 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29017 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29018 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29020 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29021 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29023 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29024 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29027 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29028 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29029 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29030 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29031 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29034 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29035 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29036 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29037 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29038 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29039 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29041 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29043 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29044 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29045 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29046 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29047 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29050 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29051 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29052 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29053 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29054 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29055 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29056 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29057 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29059 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29060 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29061 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29063 &`OK `& match succeeded
29064 &`FAIL `& match failed
29065 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29067 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29068 inability to contact a database.
29070 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29072 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29073 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29074 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29076 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29078 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29079 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29080 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29082 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29084 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29087 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29089 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29090 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29091 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29092 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29093 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29094 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29097 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29099 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29100 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29101 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29102 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29103 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29104 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29107 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29108 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29109 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29110 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29112 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29113 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29114 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29115 value afterwards. For example:
29117 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29118 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29119 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29122 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29123 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29124 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29125 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29132 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29133 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29134 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29135 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29136 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29137 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29138 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29139 binary string is returned with an error message.
29141 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29142 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29143 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29145 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29146 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29147 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29148 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29149 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29151 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29152 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29153 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29155 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29156 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29157 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29158 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29162 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29163 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29166 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29167 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29168 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29169 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29170 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29171 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29172 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29173 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29176 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29177 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29179 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29180 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29181 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29182 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29183 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29184 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29185 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29187 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29188 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29190 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29191 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29192 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29193 multiple output lines.
29195 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29196 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29197 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29198 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29199 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29200 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29201 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29204 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29205 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29206 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29207 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29209 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29210 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29211 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29213 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29216 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29219 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29220 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29221 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29222 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29223 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29224 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29230 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29231 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29232 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29233 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29234 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29235 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29236 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29239 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29240 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29241 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29242 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29244 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29245 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29247 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29249 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29250 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29251 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29252 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29254 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29255 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29256 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29257 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29267 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29268 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29269 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29270 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29271 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29272 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29273 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29274 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29276 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29277 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29278 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29279 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29280 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29282 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29283 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29284 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29285 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29286 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29287 prevent it happening on retries.
29289 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29290 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29291 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29292 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29293 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29294 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29295 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29296 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29299 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29300 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29301 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29302 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29303 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29304 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29305 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29307 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29308 system_filter_user = exim
29310 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29311 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29312 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29313 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29314 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29315 by the &%reply%& command.
29318 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29319 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29320 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29321 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29323 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29324 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29328 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29329 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29330 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29331 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29332 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29333 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29336 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29337 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29338 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29339 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29340 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29341 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29342 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29344 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29345 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29346 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29347 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29348 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29350 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29351 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29352 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29353 to which users' filter files can refer.
29357 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29358 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29359 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29360 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29361 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29365 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29366 .cindex "freezing messages"
29367 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29368 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29369 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29370 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29371 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29372 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29373 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29374 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29375 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29376 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29378 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29380 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29382 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29383 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29384 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29385 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29386 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29389 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29390 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29391 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29392 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29394 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29395 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29396 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29397 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29398 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29399 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29400 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29401 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29402 message. For example:
29404 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29405 because it contains attachments that we are \
29406 not prepared to receive."
29409 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29410 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29411 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29412 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29413 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29414 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29417 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29418 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29420 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29421 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29422 generated by the filter.
29424 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29426 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29427 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29433 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29434 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29439 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29440 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29441 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29442 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29443 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29445 headers add <string>
29446 headers remove <string>
29448 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29449 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29450 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29451 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29452 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29454 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29455 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29456 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29459 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29460 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29463 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29464 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29465 space after input continuations is ignored.
29467 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29468 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29469 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29470 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29471 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29473 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29474 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29475 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29476 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29477 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29478 used for all recipients of the message.
29480 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29481 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29482 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29483 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29484 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29485 until the message is actually being written (see section
29486 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29488 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29489 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29490 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29491 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29492 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29493 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29494 modified more than once.
29496 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29497 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29500 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29501 headers remove "Subject"
29502 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29503 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29508 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29509 .cindex "envelope sender"
29510 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29512 errors_to <some address>
29514 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29515 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29516 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29519 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29521 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29522 address if its delivery failed.
29526 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29527 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29528 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29529 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29530 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29531 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29532 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29533 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29534 which implements such a filter:
29539 domains = +local_domains
29540 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29545 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29546 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29547 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29548 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29550 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29551 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29552 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29553 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29555 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29556 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29557 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29567 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29568 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29569 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29570 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29571 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29572 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29573 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29574 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29576 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29577 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29578 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29579 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29580 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29582 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29583 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29584 loopback interface specially in any way.
29586 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29587 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29592 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29593 .cindex "message" "submission"
29594 .cindex "submission mode"
29595 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29596 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29597 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29598 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29600 control = submission
29602 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29603 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29604 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29605 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29606 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29607 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29609 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29610 control = submission
29612 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29613 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29614 is used to separate options. For example:
29616 control = submission/sender_retain
29618 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29619 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29620 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29621 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29622 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29623 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29624 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29626 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29627 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29630 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29632 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29633 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29634 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29635 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29637 accept authenticated = *
29638 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29639 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29640 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29642 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29643 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29644 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29646 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29648 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29651 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29653 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29654 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29655 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29656 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29658 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29659 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29660 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29661 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29662 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29663 spoof another's address.
29665 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29666 .cindex "line endings"
29667 .cindex "carriage return"
29669 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29670 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29671 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29672 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29673 use CRLF or just CR.
29675 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29676 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29677 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29678 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29679 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29680 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29681 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29682 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29686 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29688 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29691 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29692 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29695 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29696 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29697 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29698 people trying to play silly games.
29700 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29701 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29709 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29710 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29711 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29712 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29713 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29714 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29715 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29716 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29718 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29719 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29720 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29721 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29722 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29724 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29725 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29726 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29727 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29728 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29729 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29730 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29731 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29736 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29737 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29738 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29739 .cindex "sender" "address"
29740 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29741 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29742 .cindex "envelope sender"
29743 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29744 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29745 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29746 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29748 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29749 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29751 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29752 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29753 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29754 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29755 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29756 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29757 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29758 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29759 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29761 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29762 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29763 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29764 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29765 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29766 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29767 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29769 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29770 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29771 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29773 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29774 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29775 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29776 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29780 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29781 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29782 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29783 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29784 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29785 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29786 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29789 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29790 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29793 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29794 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29798 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29799 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29801 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29802 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29803 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29805 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29808 For a locally-submitted message,
29809 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29810 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29811 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29812 included in log lines in this case.
29814 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29815 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29821 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29822 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29823 includes the header line:
29825 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29828 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29829 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29830 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29831 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29832 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29833 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29836 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29837 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29838 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29839 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29840 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29842 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29843 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29844 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29845 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29846 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29847 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29848 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29849 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29853 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29854 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29855 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29856 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29857 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29858 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29859 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29860 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29864 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29865 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29866 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29867 .cindex "message" "submission"
29868 .cindex "submission mode"
29869 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29870 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29873 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29874 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29876 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29877 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29879 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29880 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29881 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29883 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29884 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29886 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29887 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29891 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29893 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29894 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29895 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29896 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29897 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29898 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29899 &%qualify_domain%&.
29901 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29902 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29903 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29904 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29907 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29908 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29909 .cindex "message" "submission"
29910 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29911 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29912 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29913 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29914 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29915 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29916 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29917 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29918 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29919 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29922 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29923 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29924 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29925 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29926 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29928 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29929 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29930 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29931 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29933 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29934 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29935 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29938 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29939 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
29940 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
29941 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
29942 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
29943 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
29944 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
29945 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
29946 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
29947 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
29948 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
29952 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
29953 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
29954 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
29955 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
29956 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
29957 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
29958 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
29959 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
29963 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
29964 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
29965 .cindex "message" "submission"
29966 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
29967 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
29968 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
29969 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29972 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
29973 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29974 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
29975 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
29976 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
29977 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
29978 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
29979 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
29980 line is added to the message.
29982 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
29983 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
29984 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
29985 options true at the same time.
29987 .cindex "submission mode"
29988 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
29989 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
29990 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
29991 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
29993 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29994 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
29995 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
29996 created as follows:
29999 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30000 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30001 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30003 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30004 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30006 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30007 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30010 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30011 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30012 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30013 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30015 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30016 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30017 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30018 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30022 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30023 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30024 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30025 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30026 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30027 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30028 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30029 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30030 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30032 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30033 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30034 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30035 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30036 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30037 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30039 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30040 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30041 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30043 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30044 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30045 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30047 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30048 X-added-second: another added header line
30050 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30052 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30053 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30054 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30055 not part of the names. For example:
30057 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30059 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30060 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30061 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30062 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30063 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30065 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30066 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30067 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30068 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30070 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30071 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30072 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30075 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30076 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30077 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30078 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30079 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30080 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30081 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30083 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30084 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30085 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30086 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30088 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30089 the following consequences:
30092 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30093 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30094 to it, at all times.
30096 Header lines that are added by a router's
30097 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30098 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30100 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30101 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30103 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30104 a later router or by a transport.
30106 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30107 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30109 headers_remove = subject
30110 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30114 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30115 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30121 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30122 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30123 .cindex "constructed address"
30124 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30127 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30131 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30133 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30134 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30135 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30136 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30137 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30138 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30139 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30140 there is no password file entry.
30143 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30144 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30145 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30146 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30147 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30148 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30149 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30150 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30154 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30155 .cindex "case of local parts"
30156 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30157 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30158 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30159 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30160 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30161 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30162 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30165 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30166 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30167 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30168 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30169 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30173 domains = +local_domains
30174 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30175 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30178 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30179 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30180 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30181 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30182 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30186 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30187 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30188 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30189 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30190 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30191 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30192 empty components for compatibility.
30196 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30197 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30198 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30199 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30200 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30201 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30203 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30204 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30205 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30206 example, a header such as
30210 might get rewritten as
30212 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30214 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30215 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30218 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30219 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30220 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30221 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30222 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30223 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30224 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30231 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30232 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30233 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30234 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30235 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30236 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30237 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30240 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30242 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30244 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30247 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30250 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30252 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30255 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30258 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30259 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30262 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30263 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30264 used to contain the envelope information.
30268 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30269 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30270 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30271 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30272 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30275 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30276 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30277 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30278 processing is the same in both cases.
30280 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30281 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30282 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30283 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30284 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30285 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30286 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30287 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30290 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30291 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30292 required for the transaction.
30294 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30295 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30296 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30298 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30299 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30300 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30302 .cindex "carriage return"
30304 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30305 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30306 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30309 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30310 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30311 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30312 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30313 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30314 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30315 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30316 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30317 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30319 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30320 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30321 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30322 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30324 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30325 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30326 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30327 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30329 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30330 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30331 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30332 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30333 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30334 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30335 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30336 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30337 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30338 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30340 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30341 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30343 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30344 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30345 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30346 square bracket of the IP address.
30351 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30352 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30353 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30354 .cindex "host" "error"
30355 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30356 message errors, and recipient errors.
30359 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30360 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30361 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30364 Connection refused or timed out,
30366 Any error response code on connection,
30368 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30370 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30372 I/O errors at any time,
30374 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30375 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30378 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30379 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30380 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30381 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30382 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30383 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30384 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30385 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30387 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30388 .cindex "message" "error"
30389 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30390 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30391 message errors are:
30394 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30397 Timeout after MAIL,
30399 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30400 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30401 connection at any other time.
30404 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30405 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30406 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30407 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30408 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30409 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30410 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30411 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30412 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30413 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30415 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30416 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30417 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30420 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30421 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30422 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30423 recipient errors are:
30426 Any error response to RCPT,
30428 Timeout after RCPT.
30431 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30432 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30433 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30434 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30435 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30436 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30437 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30438 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30439 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30440 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30441 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30442 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30443 the retry clock is reset.
30445 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30446 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30447 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30448 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30449 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30450 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30451 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30452 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30453 recipient's retry time.
30456 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30457 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30458 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30459 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30460 until the next delivery attempt.
30462 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30463 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30464 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30465 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30466 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30469 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30470 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30471 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30472 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30473 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30474 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30475 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30477 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30478 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30479 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30480 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30481 then to be treated as a host error.
30483 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30484 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30485 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30486 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30487 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30492 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30493 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30494 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30497 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30498 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30499 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30501 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30503 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30504 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30505 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30506 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30507 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30508 stream and exits with an error code.
30510 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30511 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30512 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30513 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30515 .cindex "carriage return"
30517 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30518 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30519 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30521 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30522 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30523 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30525 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30526 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30527 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30528 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30529 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30530 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30531 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30532 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30534 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30535 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30536 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30537 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30538 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30539 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30540 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30541 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30542 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30544 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30545 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30546 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30548 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30549 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30550 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30551 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30552 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30554 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30555 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30556 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30557 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30558 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30559 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30560 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30562 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30563 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30564 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30565 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30566 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30568 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30569 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30570 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30571 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30572 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30573 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30574 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30575 a delivery process.
30577 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30578 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30579 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30580 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30581 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30583 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30584 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30585 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30586 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30588 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30589 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30590 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30594 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30595 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30596 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30597 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30598 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30599 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30600 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30601 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30604 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30605 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30606 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30607 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30608 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30609 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30610 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30611 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30612 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30613 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30614 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30618 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30619 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30620 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30621 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30622 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30623 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30624 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30625 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30627 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30628 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30629 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30630 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30631 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30634 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30635 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30636 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30638 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30639 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30640 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30641 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30642 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30647 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30648 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30649 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30650 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30651 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30653 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30654 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30655 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30657 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30658 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30659 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30660 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30661 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30662 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30663 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30668 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30669 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30670 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30671 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30672 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30673 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30674 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30676 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30677 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30678 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30679 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30680 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30681 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30682 argument. For example,
30690 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30691 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30692 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30693 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30694 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30696 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30697 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30698 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30699 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30700 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30701 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30702 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30703 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30705 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30706 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30707 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30708 whatever the form of its argument. For
30711 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30712 $sender_host_address
30714 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30715 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30716 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30717 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30718 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30719 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30720 for it to change them before running the command.
30724 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30725 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30726 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30727 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30728 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30729 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30730 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30731 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30732 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30733 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30734 runs for RCPT commands:
30738 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30742 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30743 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30744 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30745 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30746 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30747 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30748 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30749 envelope along with the message.
30751 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30752 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30753 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30754 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30755 can be used to specify it.
30757 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30758 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30759 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30760 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30761 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30764 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30765 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30766 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30771 driver = manualroute
30772 transport = smtp_appendfile
30773 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30777 driver = appendfile
30778 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30783 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30784 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30785 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30789 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30790 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30791 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30792 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30793 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30794 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30795 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30796 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30797 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30798 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30800 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30801 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30803 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30804 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30805 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30806 make some use of automatically, for example:
30808 554 Unexpected end of file
30809 Transaction started in line 10
30810 Error detected in line 14
30812 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30815 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30816 The error message was:
30818 501 '>' missing at end of address
30820 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30821 The error was detected in line 12.
30822 The SMTP command at fault was:
30824 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30826 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30827 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30829 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30830 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30832 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30833 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30840 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30841 "Customizing messages"
30842 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30843 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30844 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30845 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30846 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30848 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30849 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30850 option. Exim also adds the line
30852 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30854 to all warning and bounce messages,
30857 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30858 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30859 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30860 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30861 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30862 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30863 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30865 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30866 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30867 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30868 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30869 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30872 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30873 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30874 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30875 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30876 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30877 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30878 option, rounded to a whole number.
30880 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30883 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30884 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30886 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30887 failing addresses with their error messages.
30889 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30890 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30892 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30893 as part of the error report.
30895 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30896 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30898 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30901 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30902 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30903 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30905 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30906 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30907 {: returning message to sender}}
30909 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30911 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30912 {that you sent }{sent by
30916 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30917 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30919 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30921 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30924 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30926 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30929 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30930 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30931 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30932 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30933 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30937 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30938 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30940 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
30941 the delayed addresses.
30943 The third item then ends the message.
30946 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
30947 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
30949 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
30950 $warn_message_delay
30952 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30954 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
30955 {that you sent }{sent by
30959 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
30960 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
30962 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
30963 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
30964 The date of the message is: $h_date
30966 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
30968 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
30969 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
30970 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
30971 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
30972 the message will be returned to you.
30974 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
30975 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
30976 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
30977 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
30978 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
30979 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
30980 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
30981 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
30987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30990 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
30991 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
30992 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
30996 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
30997 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
30998 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
30999 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31000 routing explicitly:
31002 send_to_smart_host:
31003 driver = manualroute
31004 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31005 transport = remote_smtp
31007 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31008 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31009 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31010 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31011 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31016 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31017 .cindex "mailing lists"
31018 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31019 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31020 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31022 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31023 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31024 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31025 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31029 domains = lists.example
31030 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31033 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31036 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31037 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31038 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31039 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31041 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31042 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31045 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31046 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31047 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31048 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31049 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31051 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31052 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31053 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31054 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31055 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31056 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31057 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31058 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31059 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31063 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31064 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31065 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31066 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31067 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31068 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31069 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31071 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31072 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31073 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31074 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31075 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31079 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31080 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31081 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31082 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31083 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31084 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31085 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31086 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31087 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31088 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31090 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31091 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31092 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31093 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31094 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31095 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31096 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31097 pre-existing messages.
31099 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31100 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31101 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31102 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31103 one level of expansion anyway.
31107 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31108 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31109 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31110 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31111 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31112 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31114 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31115 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31119 domains = lists.example
31120 local_part_suffix = -request
31121 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31126 domains = lists.example
31127 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31128 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31129 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31132 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31137 domains = lists.example
31139 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31141 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31142 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31143 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31146 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31147 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31148 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31149 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31150 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31151 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31152 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31153 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31154 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31156 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31157 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31158 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31163 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31165 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31166 .cindex "envelope sender"
31167 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31168 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31169 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31170 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31171 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31172 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31174 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31175 .oindex &%return_path%&
31176 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31177 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31178 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31179 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31180 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31181 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31182 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31188 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31189 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31191 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31192 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31193 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31194 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31195 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31196 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31197 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31200 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31202 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31203 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31204 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31205 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31206 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31207 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31209 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31210 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31211 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31212 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31216 domains = ! +local_domains
31218 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31219 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31222 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31223 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31224 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31225 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31228 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31229 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31230 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31231 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31232 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31236 domains = ! +local_domains
31237 transport = remote_smtp
31239 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31240 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31243 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31244 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31245 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31246 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31249 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31250 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31251 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31252 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31253 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31254 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31262 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31263 .cindex "virtual domains"
31264 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31265 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31269 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31270 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31271 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31273 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31274 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31275 have login accounts on that host.
31278 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31279 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31280 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31281 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31282 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31283 to a router of this form:
31287 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31288 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31291 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31292 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31293 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31294 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31295 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31296 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31298 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31299 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31300 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31301 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31303 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31304 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31305 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31309 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31310 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31311 transport = my_mailboxes
31313 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31314 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31315 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31316 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31317 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31321 driver = appendfile
31322 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31325 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31326 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31328 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31329 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31330 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31331 information about the domains.
31335 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31336 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31337 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31338 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31339 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31340 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31341 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31342 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31343 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31344 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31345 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31346 example, consider this router:
31351 file = $home/.forward
31352 local_part_suffix = -*
31353 local_part_suffix_optional
31356 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31357 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31358 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31359 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31361 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31362 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31365 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31366 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31367 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31368 control over which suffixes are valid.
31370 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31371 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31377 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31378 local_part_suffix = -*
31379 local_part_suffix_optional
31382 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31383 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31384 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31385 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31386 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31390 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31391 .cindex "vacation processing"
31392 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31393 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31394 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31395 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31396 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31399 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31400 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31401 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31402 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31404 spqr, vacation-spqr
31407 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31408 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31409 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31410 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31411 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31415 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31416 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31420 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31421 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31422 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31423 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31424 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31425 each day's messages.
31427 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31428 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31429 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31430 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31434 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31435 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31436 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31437 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31438 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31439 permanently connected.
31441 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31442 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31443 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31446 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31447 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31448 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31449 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31450 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31451 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31452 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31453 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31455 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31456 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31457 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31458 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31459 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31460 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31463 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31464 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31465 intermittent host. For example:
31467 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31469 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31470 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31471 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31472 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31473 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31474 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31477 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31478 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31479 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31480 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31481 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31482 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31483 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31487 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31488 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31489 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31490 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31491 delivered immediately.
31493 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31494 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31495 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31496 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31497 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31498 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31499 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31500 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31501 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31502 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31503 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31504 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31505 single SMTP connection.
31509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31512 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31513 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31514 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31515 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31516 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31517 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31518 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31519 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31520 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31521 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31524 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31525 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31526 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31527 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31528 email is not desirable.
31530 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31531 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31532 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31533 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31534 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31535 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31536 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31538 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31539 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31540 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31541 before sending a message to the smart host.
31543 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31544 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31545 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31547 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31548 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31549 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31550 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31551 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31552 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31553 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31555 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31559 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31560 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31562 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31563 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31564 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31565 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31566 successful, a zero return code is given.
31568 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31569 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31570 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31571 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31572 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31575 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31576 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31577 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31579 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31580 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31581 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31582 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31583 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31585 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31586 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31587 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31589 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31590 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31591 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31592 are ever generated.
31594 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31596 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31597 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31598 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31601 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31602 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31603 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31604 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31605 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31606 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31614 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31615 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31616 .cindex "log" "types of"
31617 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31622 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31623 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31624 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31625 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31626 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31627 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31628 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31629 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31631 .cindex "reject log"
31632 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31633 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31634 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31635 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31636 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31637 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31638 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31639 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31640 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31643 .cindex "panic log"
31644 .cindex "system log"
31645 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31646 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31647 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31648 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31649 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31650 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31651 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31652 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31653 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31656 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31657 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31658 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31660 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31663 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31664 ways of changing this:
31667 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31672 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31674 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31677 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31681 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31682 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31683 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31684 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31685 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31686 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31691 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31692 .cindex "log" "destination"
31693 .cindex "log" "to file"
31694 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31696 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31697 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31698 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31699 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31700 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31701 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31702 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31704 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31705 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31706 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31707 references to the host name:
31709 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31711 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31712 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31713 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31714 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31715 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31718 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31719 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31720 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31721 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31722 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31723 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31724 implying the use of a default path.
31726 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31727 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31728 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31729 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31730 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31731 equivalent to the setting:
31733 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31735 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31738 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31739 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31741 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31743 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31744 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31745 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31746 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31748 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31753 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31754 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31755 .cindex "cycling logs"
31756 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31757 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31758 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31759 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31760 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31761 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31762 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31764 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31765 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31766 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31767 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31768 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31769 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31770 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31771 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31772 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31773 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31774 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31779 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31780 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31781 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31782 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31783 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31784 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31785 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31786 datestamp is required. For example:
31788 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31789 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31790 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31792 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31793 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31795 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31796 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31797 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31799 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31800 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31801 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31802 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31804 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31805 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31806 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31807 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31808 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31809 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31811 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31812 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31813 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31817 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31818 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31819 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31820 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31821 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31822 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31823 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31824 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31825 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31826 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31827 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31828 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31829 the time and host name to each line.
31830 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31833 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31835 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31837 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31840 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31841 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31842 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31843 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31845 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31846 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31847 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31848 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31849 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31850 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31851 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31852 RFC 3164, you should set
31854 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31856 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31857 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31859 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31860 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31861 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31862 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31863 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31864 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31865 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31866 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31867 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31869 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31870 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31871 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31872 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31875 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31878 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31879 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31880 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31881 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31883 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31884 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31885 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31886 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31887 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31888 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31890 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31891 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31892 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31895 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31897 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31898 without modification.
31900 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31901 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31902 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31907 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31908 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31909 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31910 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31911 timestamp. The flags are:
31913 &`<=`& message arrival
31914 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31915 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31916 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31917 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31918 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31922 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31923 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31924 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31925 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31926 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31928 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31929 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31930 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31932 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31933 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31934 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31938 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
31942 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
31943 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
31944 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
31945 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
31946 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
31947 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
31948 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
31949 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
31950 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
31951 name in parentheses.
31953 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
31954 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
31955 the log containing text like these examples:
31957 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
31958 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
31960 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
31963 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
31964 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
31967 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
31968 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
31969 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
31970 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
31971 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
31972 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
31973 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
31974 suite that was used.
31976 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
31977 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
31978 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
31979 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
31980 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
31981 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
31982 authenticator name.
31984 .cindex "size" "of message"
31985 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
31986 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
31987 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
31988 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
31991 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
31992 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
31996 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
31997 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
31998 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31999 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32000 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32001 to fit it on the page:
32003 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32004 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32005 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32006 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32007 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32009 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32010 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32011 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32012 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32013 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32015 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32016 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32018 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32020 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32021 parentheses afterwards.
32023 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32024 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32025 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32026 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32027 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32028 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32030 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32031 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32033 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32034 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32037 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32038 .cindex "discarded messages"
32039 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32040 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32041 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32042 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32044 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32045 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32047 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32048 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32050 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32051 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32055 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32056 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32058 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32059 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32061 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32062 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32063 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32065 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32066 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32068 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32069 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32070 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32074 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32075 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32076 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32077 following form is logged:
32079 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32080 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32082 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32083 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32085 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32086 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32087 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32088 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32089 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32091 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32092 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32093 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32094 flagged with &`**`&.
32098 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32099 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32100 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32101 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32102 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32106 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32109 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32111 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32112 at the end of its processing.
32117 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32118 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32119 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32120 the following table:
32122 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32123 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32124 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32125 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32126 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32127 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32128 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32129 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32130 &`H `& host name and IP address
32131 &`I `& local interface used
32132 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32133 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32134 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32135 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32136 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32137 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32138 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32139 &`S `& size of message
32140 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32141 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32142 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32143 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32144 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32148 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32149 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32150 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32153 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32154 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32155 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32156 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32157 during the first delivery attempt.
32159 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32160 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32161 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32163 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32164 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32165 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32166 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32167 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32170 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32171 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32174 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32175 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32177 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32178 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32180 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32181 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32182 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32186 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32194 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32195 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32196 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32197 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32198 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32201 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32203 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32204 selection marked by asterisks:
32206 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32207 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32208 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32209 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32210 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32211 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32212 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32213 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32214 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32215 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32216 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32217 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32218 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32219 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32220 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32221 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32222 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32223 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32224 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32225 &` pid `& Exim process id
32226 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32227 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32228 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32229 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32230 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32231 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32232 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32233 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32234 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32235 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32236 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32237 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32238 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32239 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32240 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32241 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32242 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32243 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32244 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32245 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32247 &` all `& all of the above
32249 More details on each of these items follows:
32252 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32253 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32254 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32255 this log selector is set.
32257 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32258 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32259 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32260 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32261 such users cannot access the log).
32263 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32264 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32265 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32266 parentheses between them.
32268 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32269 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32270 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32271 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32272 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32273 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32274 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32275 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32276 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32277 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32278 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32279 between the caller and Exim.
32281 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32282 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32283 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32285 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32286 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32287 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32288 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32289 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32290 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32292 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32293 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32294 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32296 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32297 .cindex "size" "of message"
32298 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32299 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32301 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32302 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32303 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32304 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32305 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32307 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32308 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32309 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32310 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32311 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32312 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32314 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32315 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32316 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32317 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32318 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32320 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32321 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32322 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32323 client's ident port times out.
32325 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32326 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32327 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32328 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32329 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32330 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32333 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32334 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32335 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32336 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32337 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32338 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32339 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32340 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32341 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32342 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32343 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32345 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32346 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32347 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32349 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32350 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32352 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32353 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32354 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32355 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32357 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32358 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32359 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32360 immediately after the time and date.
32362 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32363 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32364 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32366 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32367 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32368 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32369 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32370 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32371 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32372 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32373 message has been successfully received.
32375 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32376 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32377 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32378 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32380 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32381 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32382 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32383 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32384 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32386 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32389 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32390 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32391 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32392 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32394 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32395 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32396 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32397 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32398 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32400 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32401 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32402 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32403 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32406 .cindex "log" "return path"
32407 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32408 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32409 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32410 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32412 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32413 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32414 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32415 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32416 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32418 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32419 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32420 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32421 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32424 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32425 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32428 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32429 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32430 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32431 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32433 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32434 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32436 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32437 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32438 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32439 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32440 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32443 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32444 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32445 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32446 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32447 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32448 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32449 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32450 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32451 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32452 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32454 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32455 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32456 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32457 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32458 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32459 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32460 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32461 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32463 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32464 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32465 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32466 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32467 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32468 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32470 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32471 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32472 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32473 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32474 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32475 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32476 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32477 already have their own log lines.
32479 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32480 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32481 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32482 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32483 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32484 the same logging options.
32486 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32487 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32491 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32492 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32493 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32494 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32495 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32497 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32498 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32499 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32500 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32501 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32502 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32503 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32504 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32506 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32507 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32508 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32509 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32510 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32511 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32512 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32513 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32514 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32516 .cindex "log" "subject"
32517 .cindex "subject, logging"
32518 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32519 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32520 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32521 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32522 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32524 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32525 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32526 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32527 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32529 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32530 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32531 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32532 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32534 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32535 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32536 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32537 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32538 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32540 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32541 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32542 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32546 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32547 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32548 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32549 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32550 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32551 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32552 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32553 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32554 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32555 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32556 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32557 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32558 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32560 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32561 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32562 &%message_logs%& option false.
32568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32571 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32572 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32573 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32574 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32575 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32577 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32578 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32579 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32580 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32581 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32582 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32583 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32585 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32586 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32587 "extract statistics from the log"
32588 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32589 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32590 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32591 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32592 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32593 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32594 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32595 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32598 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32599 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32600 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32605 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32606 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32607 .cindex "process, querying"
32609 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32610 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32611 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32612 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32613 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32614 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32615 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32616 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32618 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32619 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32620 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32623 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32624 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32625 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32626 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32627 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32630 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32631 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32632 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32633 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32635 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32637 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32638 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32639 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32640 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32641 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32642 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32644 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32645 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32649 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32650 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32651 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32652 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32656 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32657 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32658 options are available:
32661 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32662 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32663 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32667 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32668 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32671 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32672 Match against the size field.
32674 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32675 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32677 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32678 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32681 Match only frozen messages.
32684 Match only non-frozen messages.
32687 The following options control the format of the output:
32691 Display only the count of matching messages.
32694 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32698 Display message ids only.
32701 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32704 Display messages in reverse order.
32707 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32711 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32712 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32713 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32714 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32715 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32716 running a command such as
32718 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32720 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32721 it, as in the following example:
32723 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32725 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32726 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32727 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32728 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32730 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32731 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32732 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32733 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32734 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32735 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32738 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32739 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32740 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32741 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32742 level"& addresses).
32747 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32749 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32750 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32751 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32752 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32753 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32754 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32755 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32756 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32757 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32758 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32760 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32762 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32764 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32765 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32766 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32768 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32769 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32770 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32771 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32772 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32774 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32775 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32776 regular expression.
32778 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32779 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32781 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32782 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32783 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32786 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32787 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32788 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32789 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32790 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32791 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32792 the &%--help%& option.
32795 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32796 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32797 .cindex "cycling logs"
32798 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32799 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32800 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32801 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32802 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32803 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32804 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32806 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32807 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32809 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32810 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32811 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32815 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32816 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32817 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32818 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32819 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32820 logs are handled similarly.
32822 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32823 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32824 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32825 any existing log files.
32827 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32828 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32829 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32830 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32831 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32833 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32835 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32836 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32840 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32841 .cindex "statistics"
32842 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32843 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32844 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32845 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32846 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32848 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32849 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32850 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32851 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32852 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32854 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32856 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32857 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32858 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32859 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32860 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32861 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32862 also produced per user.
32864 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32865 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32866 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32867 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32868 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32870 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32871 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32872 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32873 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32874 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32875 an entirely separate message.
32877 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32878 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32879 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32880 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32881 least one address that failed.
32883 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32884 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32885 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32886 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32887 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32888 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32889 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32891 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32892 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32893 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32895 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32896 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32897 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32899 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32902 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32903 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32904 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32905 .cindex "checking access"
32906 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32907 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32908 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32909 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32910 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32911 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32913 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32914 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32916 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32918 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32919 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32920 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32921 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32924 550 Relay not permitted
32926 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32927 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32928 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32929 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32932 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32933 -f himself@there.example
32935 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32936 mandatory arguments.
32938 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32939 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
32940 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
32944 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
32945 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
32946 .cindex "building DBM files"
32947 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
32948 .cindex "lower casing"
32949 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
32950 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
32951 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
32952 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
32953 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
32954 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
32956 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
32957 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
32958 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
32959 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
32962 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
32963 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
32964 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
32968 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
32969 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
32970 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
32971 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
32973 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
32975 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
32976 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
32978 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
32979 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
32980 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
32981 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
32982 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
32983 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
32985 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
32986 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
32987 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
32988 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
32989 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
32990 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
32991 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
32997 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
32998 .cindex "retry" "times"
32999 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33000 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33001 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33002 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33003 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33004 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33005 output. For example:
33007 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33008 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33009 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33010 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33011 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33012 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33013 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33014 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33015 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33016 past final cutoff time
33018 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33019 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33020 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33021 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33022 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33023 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33026 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33027 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33028 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33029 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33030 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33031 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33035 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33036 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33037 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33038 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33039 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33040 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33041 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33044 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33046 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33049 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33051 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33053 &'misc'&: other hints data
33056 The &'misc'& database is used for
33059 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33061 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33062 &(smtp)& transport)
33067 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33068 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33069 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33070 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33071 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33073 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33075 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33077 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33078 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33080 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33081 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33082 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33083 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33084 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33085 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33086 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33087 and a textual description of the error.
33089 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33090 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33091 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33094 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33095 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33096 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33097 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33098 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33099 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33104 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33105 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33106 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33107 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33108 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33109 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33110 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33111 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33112 updated sufficiently often.
33114 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33115 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33116 the retry database:
33118 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33120 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33121 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33122 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33123 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33124 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33125 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33126 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33127 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33128 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33129 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33130 whenever it removes information from the database.
33132 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33133 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33134 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33135 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33136 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33138 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33139 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33140 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33141 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33142 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33143 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33144 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33147 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33148 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33153 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33154 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33155 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33156 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33157 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33158 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33159 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33162 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33163 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33164 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33165 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33166 by new data, for example:
33170 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33171 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33172 used as optional separators.
33177 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33178 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33179 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33180 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33181 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33182 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33183 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33184 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33185 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33186 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33187 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33188 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33189 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33193 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33196 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33199 .vitem &%-interval%&
33200 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33201 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33203 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33204 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33207 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33210 Suppress verification output.
33212 .vitem &%-retries%&
33213 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33214 the lock (default 10).
33216 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33217 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33218 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33219 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33222 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33223 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33224 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33225 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33228 Generate verbose output.
33231 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33232 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33233 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33234 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33235 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33236 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33237 more than 30 minutes old.
33239 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33240 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33241 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33242 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33243 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33244 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33246 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33247 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33248 suppresses all output except error messages.
33252 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33254 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33256 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33257 <&'some commands'&>
33260 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33261 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33264 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33265 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33267 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33268 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33275 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33276 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33277 .cindex "X-windows"
33278 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33279 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33280 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33281 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33282 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33283 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33284 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33285 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33289 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33290 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33291 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33292 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33293 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33294 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33295 parameters are for.
33297 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33298 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33299 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33301 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33303 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33304 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33305 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33306 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33307 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33309 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33310 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33312 Eximon*background: gray94
33314 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33315 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33316 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33317 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33318 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33319 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33320 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33323 Eximon*highlight: gray
33326 .cindex "admin user"
33327 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33328 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33330 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33331 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33332 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33333 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33334 different parts of the display.
33339 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33340 .cindex "stripchart"
33341 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33342 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33343 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33344 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33345 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33346 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33347 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33348 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33349 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33351 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33352 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33353 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33354 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33356 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33357 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33358 to a single partition.
33360 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33361 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33362 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33363 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33364 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33365 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33366 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33371 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33372 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33373 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33374 .cindex "window size"
33375 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33376 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33377 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33378 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33379 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33380 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33382 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33383 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33384 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33385 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33387 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33388 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33389 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33390 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33391 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33392 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33394 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33395 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33396 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33400 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33401 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33402 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33403 the main log is maintained.
33404 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33405 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33406 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33407 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33408 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33410 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33411 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33412 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33413 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33414 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33415 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33416 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33417 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33418 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33419 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33420 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33422 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33423 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33424 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33425 It cannot go further back up the log.
33427 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33428 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33429 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33430 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33431 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33432 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33434 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33435 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33436 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33437 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33438 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33439 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33441 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33442 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33443 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33444 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33445 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33446 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33447 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33448 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33449 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33454 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33455 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33456 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33457 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33458 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33459 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33460 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33461 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33462 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33463 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33465 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33466 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33467 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33468 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33469 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33470 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33471 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33473 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33474 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33475 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33476 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33477 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33478 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33479 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33481 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33482 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33483 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33484 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33486 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33487 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33488 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33489 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33490 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33491 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33492 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33495 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33496 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33498 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33499 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33500 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33501 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33502 display is updated.
33506 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33507 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33508 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33509 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33510 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33513 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33514 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33515 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33516 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33517 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33519 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33521 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33525 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33526 in a new text window.
33528 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33529 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33530 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33532 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33533 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33534 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33535 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33537 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33538 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33539 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33540 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33541 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33543 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33544 that the message be frozen.
33546 .cindex "thawing messages"
33547 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33548 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33549 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33550 that the message be thawed.
33552 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33553 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33554 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33555 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33557 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33558 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33561 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33562 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33563 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33564 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33565 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33566 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33567 which case no action is taken.
33569 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33570 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33571 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33572 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33573 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33574 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33575 case no action is taken.
33577 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33578 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33580 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33581 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33582 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33583 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33584 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33585 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33586 the address is qualified with that domain.
33589 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33590 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33591 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33592 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33593 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33594 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33595 if no output is generated.
33597 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33598 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33599 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33600 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33602 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33603 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33604 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33614 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33615 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33616 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33617 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33619 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33620 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33621 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33622 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33623 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33624 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33626 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33627 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33628 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33629 as soon as possible.
33632 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33633 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33634 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33635 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33636 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33637 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33640 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33641 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33642 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33643 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33644 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33645 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33647 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33648 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33649 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33650 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33652 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33653 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33654 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33655 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33656 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33657 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33658 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33659 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33660 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33662 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33665 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33666 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33667 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33668 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33669 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33675 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33677 .cindex "root privilege"
33678 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33679 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33680 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33681 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33682 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33683 is required for two things:
33686 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33687 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33690 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33691 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33695 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33696 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33697 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33698 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33699 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33700 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33701 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33702 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33704 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33705 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33706 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33708 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33709 uid and gid in the following cases:
33714 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33715 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33716 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33717 changed to those of the calling process.
33718 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33719 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33720 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33725 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33726 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33729 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33730 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33731 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33732 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33733 testing address verification
33736 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33739 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33740 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33743 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33746 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33747 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33748 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33749 will be used during message reception.
33751 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33752 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33754 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33755 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33756 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33757 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33758 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33759 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33760 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33761 generating bounce and warning messages.
33763 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33764 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33765 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33766 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33768 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33769 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33775 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33776 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33777 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33778 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33779 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33780 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33781 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33782 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33783 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33784 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33788 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33789 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33790 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33791 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33793 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33794 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33795 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33796 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33797 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33799 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33800 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33801 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33804 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33805 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33806 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33808 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33809 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33810 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33811 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33812 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33813 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33814 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33815 address this problem at this time.
33817 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33818 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33819 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33820 be used in the most straightforward way.
33822 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33823 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33826 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33827 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33828 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33829 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33830 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33832 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33833 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33835 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33836 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33837 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33838 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33840 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33841 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33844 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33845 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33846 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33848 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33849 owned by the Exim user.
33851 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33852 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33853 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33858 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33859 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33860 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33861 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33863 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33864 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33869 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33870 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33871 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33875 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33876 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33877 .cindex "IP source routing"
33878 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33879 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33880 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33881 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33885 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33886 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33887 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33892 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33893 .cindex "trusted users"
33894 .cindex "admin user"
33895 .cindex "privileged user"
33896 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33897 .cindex "user" "admin"
33898 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33899 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33900 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33901 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33902 permit a remote host to be specified.
33905 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33906 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33907 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33908 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33909 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33910 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33912 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33913 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33914 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33915 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33916 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33918 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33919 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33920 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33921 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33922 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33926 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33927 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33928 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33929 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33930 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33931 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33933 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33934 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33935 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33936 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33937 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33938 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
33943 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
33944 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
33945 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
33946 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
33947 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
33948 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
33952 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
33953 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
33954 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
33955 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
33956 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
33961 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
33962 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
33963 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
33964 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
33969 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
33970 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
33971 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
33972 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
33973 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
33977 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
33978 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
33979 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
33980 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
33981 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
33982 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
33983 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
33985 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
33986 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
33991 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
33992 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
33993 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
33994 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
33998 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
33999 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34000 enough to hold the result.
34001 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34006 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34007 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34009 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34010 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34011 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34012 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34013 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34014 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34015 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34016 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34017 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34018 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34019 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34020 themselves are recoverable.
34022 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34023 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34024 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34027 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34028 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34029 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34030 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34031 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34033 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34034 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34035 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34036 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34037 will always be the case.
34039 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34041 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34044 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34046 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34047 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34048 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34049 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34050 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34051 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34052 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34053 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34056 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34057 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34058 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34059 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34060 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34061 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34062 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34063 normally the Exim user.
34065 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34066 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34067 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34068 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34069 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34070 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34071 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34072 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34074 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34075 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34076 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34077 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34079 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34080 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34083 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34084 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34085 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34086 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34087 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34088 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34089 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34090 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34091 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34094 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34095 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34096 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34097 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34098 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34099 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34101 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34102 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34103 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34104 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34105 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34106 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34108 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34109 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34110 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34112 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34113 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34114 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34115 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34116 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34118 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34119 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34120 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34121 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34122 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34124 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34125 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34126 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34128 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34129 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34130 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34132 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34133 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34136 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34137 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34138 present if the number is greater than zero.
34140 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34141 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34142 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34144 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34145 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34146 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34148 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34149 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34152 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34153 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34154 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34157 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34158 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34159 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34160 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34162 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34163 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34164 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34166 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34167 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34168 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34169 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34170 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34171 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34173 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34174 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34175 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34176 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34177 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34179 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34180 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34181 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34182 generated messages.
34185 The message is from a local sender.
34187 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34188 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34190 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34191 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34192 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34193 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34195 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34196 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34197 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34200 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34201 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34204 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34205 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34206 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34208 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34209 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34210 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34212 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34213 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34214 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34216 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34217 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34218 certificate was verified by the server.
34220 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34221 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34222 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34224 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34225 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34226 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34230 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34231 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34232 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34233 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34234 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34235 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34236 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34237 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34238 addresses are complete.
34240 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34241 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34242 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34243 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34244 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34245 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34247 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34248 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34249 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34251 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34252 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34253 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34254 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34258 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34259 darcy@austen.fict.example
34261 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34263 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34264 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34265 line is of the following form:
34267 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34268 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34270 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34271 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34272 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34273 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34274 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34275 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34276 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34277 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34280 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34281 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34282 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34283 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34284 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34288 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34289 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34290 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34291 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34292 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34293 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34294 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34295 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34296 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34297 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34300 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34301 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34302 typical set of headers:
34304 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34305 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34306 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34307 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34308 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34309 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34310 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34311 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34312 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34313 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34314 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34316 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34317 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34318 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34319 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34320 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34321 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34329 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID12" &&&
34330 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34331 .cindex "adding drivers"
34332 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34333 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34334 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34335 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34338 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34339 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34341 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34343 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34345 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34346 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34347 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34349 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34351 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34354 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34355 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34357 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34358 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34359 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34361 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34364 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34365 as for other drivers and lookups.
34368 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34369 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34370 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34371 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34372 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34374 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34375 the interface that is expected.
34380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34383 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34384 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34385 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34386 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34388 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34393 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34394 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34398 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34399 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34400 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34403 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34404 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////